Automatic date update in version.in
[binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-xtensa.c
1 /* Xtensa-specific support for 32-bit ELF.
2 Copyright (C) 2003-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
5
6 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
7 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
8 published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the
9 License, or (at your option) any later version.
10
11 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
12 WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
13 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
14 General Public License for more details.
15
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
18 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
19 02110-1301, USA. */
20
21 #include "sysdep.h"
22 #include "bfd.h"
23
24 #include <stdarg.h>
25 #include <strings.h>
26
27 #include "bfdlink.h"
28 #include "libbfd.h"
29 #include "elf-bfd.h"
30 #include "elf/xtensa.h"
31 #include "splay-tree.h"
32 #include "xtensa-isa.h"
33 #include "xtensa-config.h"
34
35 /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
36 #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
37
38 #define XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL 0
39
40 #ifndef XSHAL_ABI
41 #define XSHAL_ABI 0
42 #endif
43
44 #ifndef XTHAL_ABI_UNDEFINED
45 #define XTHAL_ABI_UNDEFINED -1
46 #endif
47
48 #ifndef XTHAL_ABI_WINDOWED
49 #define XTHAL_ABI_WINDOWED 0
50 #endif
51
52 #ifndef XTHAL_ABI_CALL0
53 #define XTHAL_ABI_CALL0 1
54 #endif
55
56 /* Local helper functions. */
57
58 static bool add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
59 static char *vsprint_msg (const char *, const char *, int, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF(2,4);
60 static bfd_reloc_status_type bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc
61 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
62 static bool do_fix_for_relocatable_link
63 (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *);
64 static void do_fix_for_final_link
65 (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_vma *);
66
67 /* Local functions to handle Xtensa configurability. */
68
69 static bool is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
70 static bool is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
71 static bool is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
72 static xtensa_opcode get_const16_opcode (void);
73 static xtensa_opcode get_l32r_opcode (void);
74 static bfd_vma l32r_offset (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
75 static int get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode, int);
76 static int get_relocation_slot (int);
77 static xtensa_opcode get_relocation_opcode
78 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
79 static bool is_l32r_relocation
80 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
81 static bool is_alt_relocation (int);
82 static bool is_operand_relocation (int);
83 static bfd_size_type insn_decode_len
84 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
85 static int insn_num_slots
86 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
87 static xtensa_opcode insn_decode_opcode
88 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type, int);
89 static bool check_branch_target_aligned
90 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
91 static bool check_loop_aligned
92 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
93 static bool check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma, int);
94 static bfd_size_type get_asm_simplify_size
95 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
96
97 /* Functions for link-time code simplifications. */
98
99 static bfd_reloc_status_type elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify
100 (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma, char **);
101 static bfd_reloc_status_type contract_asm_expansion
102 (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, Elf_Internal_Rela *, char **);
103 static xtensa_opcode swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
104 static xtensa_opcode get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *, int, bool *);
105
106 /* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols. */
107
108 static Elf_Internal_Rela *retrieve_internal_relocs
109 (bfd *, asection *, bool);
110 static void pin_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
111 static void release_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
112 static bfd_byte *retrieve_contents (bfd *, asection *, bool);
113 static void pin_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
114 static void release_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
115 static Elf_Internal_Sym *retrieve_local_syms (bfd *);
116
117 /* Miscellaneous utility functions. */
118
119 static asection *elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
120 static asection *elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
121 static asection *get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *, unsigned long);
122 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry
123 (bfd *, unsigned long);
124 static bfd_vma get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *, unsigned long);
125 static bool is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
126 static bool pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode, int, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
127 static bool xtensa_is_property_section (asection *);
128 static bool xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *);
129 static bool xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *);
130 static bool xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *);
131 static int internal_reloc_compare (const void *, const void *);
132 static int internal_reloc_matches (const void *, const void *);
133 static asection *xtensa_get_property_section (asection *, const char *);
134 static flagword xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *);
135
136 /* Other functions called directly by the linker. */
137
138 typedef void (*deps_callback_t)
139 (asection *, bfd_vma, asection *, bfd_vma, void *);
140 extern bool xtensa_callback_required_dependence
141 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, deps_callback_t, void *);
142
143
144 /* Globally visible flag for choosing size optimization of NOP removal
145 instead of branch-target-aware minimization for NOP removal.
146 When nonzero, narrow all instructions and remove all NOPs possible
147 around longcall expansions. */
148
149 int elf32xtensa_size_opt;
150
151
152 /* The "new_section_hook" is used to set up a per-section
153 "xtensa_relax_info" data structure with additional information used
154 during relaxation. */
155
156 typedef struct xtensa_relax_info_struct xtensa_relax_info;
157
158
159 /* The GNU tools do not easily allow extending interfaces to pass around
160 the pointer to the Xtensa ISA information, so instead we add a global
161 variable here (in BFD) that can be used by any of the tools that need
162 this information. */
163
164 xtensa_isa xtensa_default_isa;
165
166
167 /* When this is true, relocations may have been modified to refer to
168 symbols from other input files. The per-section list of "fix"
169 records needs to be checked when resolving relocations. */
170
171 static bool relaxing_section = false;
172
173 /* When this is true, during final links, literals that cannot be
174 coalesced and their relocations may be moved to other sections. */
175
176 int elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement = 1;
177
178 /* Place property records for a section into individual property section
179 with xt.prop. prefix. */
180
181 bool elf32xtensa_separate_props = false;
182
183 /* Xtensa ABI. It affects PLT entry code. */
184
185 int elf32xtensa_abi = XTHAL_ABI_UNDEFINED;
186
187 /* Rename one of the generic section flags to better document how it
188 is used here. */
189 /* Whether relocations have been processed. */
190 #define reloc_done sec_flg0
191 \f
192 static reloc_howto_type elf_howto_table[] =
193 {
194 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NONE, 0, 3, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
195 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NONE",
196 false, 0, 0, false),
197 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
198 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32",
199 true, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff, false),
200
201 /* Replace a 32-bit value with a value from the runtime linker (only
202 used by linker-generated stub functions). The r_addend value is
203 special: 1 means to substitute a pointer to the runtime linker's
204 dynamic resolver function; 2 means to substitute the link map for
205 the shared object. */
206 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RTLD, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
207 NULL, "R_XTENSA_RTLD", false, 0, 0, false),
208
209 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
210 bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT",
211 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
212 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
213 bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT",
214 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
215 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RELATIVE, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
216 bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_RELATIVE",
217 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
218 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PLT, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
219 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PLT",
220 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
221
222 EMPTY_HOWTO (7),
223
224 /* Old relocations for backward compatibility. */
225 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP0, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
226 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP0", false, 0, 0, true),
227 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP1, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
228 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP1", false, 0, 0, true),
229 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP2, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
230 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP2", false, 0, 0, true),
231
232 /* Assembly auto-expansion. */
233 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
234 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND", false, 0, 0, true),
235 /* Relax assembly auto-expansion. */
236 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
237 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY", false, 0, 0, true),
238
239 EMPTY_HOWTO (13),
240
241 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32_PCREL, 0, 2, 32, true, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
242 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32_PCREL",
243 false, 0, 0xffffffff, true),
244
245 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
246 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 2, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
247 NULL, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT",
248 false, 0, 0, false),
249 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
250 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 2, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
251 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY",
252 false, 0, 0, false),
253
254 /* Relocations for supporting difference of symbols. */
255 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF8, 0, 0, 8, false, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
256 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF8", false, 0, 0xff, false),
257 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF16, 0, 1, 16, false, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
258 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF16", false, 0, 0xffff, false),
259 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF32, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_signed,
260 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF32", false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
261
262 /* General immediate operand relocations. */
263 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
264 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
265 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
266 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
267 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
268 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
269 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
270 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
271 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
272 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
273 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
274 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
275 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
276 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
277 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
278 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
279 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
280 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
281 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
282 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
283 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
284 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
285 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
286 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
287 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
288 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
289 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
290 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
291 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
292 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP", false, 0, 0, true),
293
294 /* "Alternate" relocations. The meaning of these is opcode-specific. */
295 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
296 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
297 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
298 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
299 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
300 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
301 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
302 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
303 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
304 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
305 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
306 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
307 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
308 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
309 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
310 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
311 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
312 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
313 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
314 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
315 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
316 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
317 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
318 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
319 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
320 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
321 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
322 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
323 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT, 0, 0, 0, true, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
324 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT", false, 0, 0, true),
325
326 /* TLS relocations. */
327 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
328 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN",
329 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
330 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
331 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG",
332 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
333 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
334 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF",
335 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
336 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
337 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF",
338 false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
339 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC, 0, 0, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
340 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC",
341 false, 0, 0, false),
342 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG, 0, 0, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
343 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG",
344 false, 0, 0, false),
345 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL, 0, 0, 0, false, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
346 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL",
347 false, 0, 0, false),
348
349 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PDIFF8, 0, 0, 8, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
350 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PDIFF8", false, 0, 0xff, false),
351 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PDIFF16, 0, 1, 16, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
352 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PDIFF16", false, 0, 0xffff, false),
353 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PDIFF32, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
354 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PDIFF32", false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
355
356 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NDIFF8, 0, 0, 8, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
357 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NDIFF8", false, 0, 0xff, false),
358 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NDIFF16, 0, 1, 16, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
359 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NDIFF16", false, 0, 0xffff, false),
360 HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NDIFF32, 0, 2, 32, false, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
361 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NDIFF32", false, 0, 0xffffffff, false),
362 };
363
364 #if DEBUG_GEN_RELOC
365 #define TRACE(str) \
366 fprintf (stderr, "Xtensa bfd reloc lookup %d (%s)\n", code, str)
367 #else
368 #define TRACE(str)
369 #endif
370
371 static reloc_howto_type *
372 elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
373 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
374 {
375 switch (code)
376 {
377 case BFD_RELOC_NONE:
378 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_NONE");
379 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NONE ];
380
381 case BFD_RELOC_32:
382 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32");
383 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32 ];
384
385 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:
386 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL");
387 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32_PCREL ];
388
389 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8:
390 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8");
391 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF8 ];
392
393 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16:
394 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16");
395 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF16 ];
396
397 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32:
398 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32");
399 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF32 ];
400
401 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF8:
402 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF8");
403 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PDIFF8 ];
404
405 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF16:
406 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF16");
407 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PDIFF16 ];
408
409 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF32:
410 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PDIFF32");
411 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PDIFF32 ];
412
413 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF8:
414 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF8");
415 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NDIFF8 ];
416
417 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF16:
418 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF16");
419 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NDIFF16 ];
420
421 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF32:
422 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_NDIFF32");
423 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NDIFF32 ];
424
425 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD:
426 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD");
427 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RTLD ];
428
429 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT:
430 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT");
431 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT ];
432
433 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
434 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT");
435 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT ];
436
437 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
438 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE");
439 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RELATIVE ];
440
441 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT:
442 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT");
443 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PLT ];
444
445 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0:
446 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0");
447 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP0 ];
448
449 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1:
450 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1");
451 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP1 ];
452
453 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2:
454 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2");
455 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP2 ];
456
457 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
458 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND");
459 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND ];
460
461 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
462 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY");
463 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY ];
464
465 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:
466 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT");
467 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT ];
468
469 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:
470 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY");
471 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY ];
472
473 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
474 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN");
475 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN ];
476
477 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
478 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG");
479 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG ];
480
481 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
482 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF");
483 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF ];
484
485 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
486 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF");
487 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF ];
488
489 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
490 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC");
491 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC ];
492
493 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
494 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG");
495 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG ];
496
497 case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
498 TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL");
499 return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL ];
500
501 default:
502 if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP
503 && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
504 {
505 unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP +
506 (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP));
507 return &elf_howto_table[n];
508 }
509
510 if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
511 && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
512 {
513 unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT +
514 (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT));
515 return &elf_howto_table[n];
516 }
517
518 break;
519 }
520
521 /* xgettext:c-format */
522 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"), abfd, (int) code);
523 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
524 TRACE ("Unknown");
525 return NULL;
526 }
527
528 static reloc_howto_type *
529 elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
530 const char *r_name)
531 {
532 unsigned int i;
533
534 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (elf_howto_table) / sizeof (elf_howto_table[0]); i++)
535 if (elf_howto_table[i].name != NULL
536 && strcasecmp (elf_howto_table[i].name, r_name) == 0)
537 return &elf_howto_table[i];
538
539 return NULL;
540 }
541
542
543 /* Given an ELF "rela" relocation, find the corresponding howto and record
544 it in the BFD internal arelent representation of the relocation. */
545
546 static bool
547 elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela (bfd *abfd,
548 arelent *cache_ptr,
549 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
550 {
551 unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
552
553 if (r_type >= (unsigned int) R_XTENSA_max)
554 {
555 /* xgettext:c-format */
556 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
557 abfd, r_type);
558 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
559 return false;
560 }
561 cache_ptr->howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
562 return true;
563 }
564
565 \f
566 /* Functions for the Xtensa ELF linker. */
567
568 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
569 section. */
570
571 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/lib/ld.so"
572
573 /* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table.
574 (This does _not_ include the space for the literals associated with
575 the PLT entry.) */
576
577 #define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 16
578
579 /* For _really_ large PLTs, we may need to alternate between literals
580 and code to keep the literals within the 256K range of the L32R
581 instructions in the code. It's unlikely that anyone would ever need
582 such a big PLT, but an arbitrary limit on the PLT size would be bad.
583 Thus, we split the PLT into chunks. Since there's very little
584 overhead (2 extra literals) for each chunk, the chunk size is kept
585 small so that the code for handling multiple chunks get used and
586 tested regularly. With 254 entries, there are 1K of literals for
587 each chunk, and that seems like a nice round number. */
588
589 #define PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK 254
590
591 /* PLT entries are actually used as stub functions for lazy symbol
592 resolution. Once the symbol is resolved, the stub function is never
593 invoked. Note: the 32-byte frame size used here cannot be changed
594 without a corresponding change in the runtime linker. */
595
596 static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry[][PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
597 {
598 {
599 0x6c, 0x10, 0x04, /* entry sp, 32 */
600 0x18, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
601 0x1a, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
602 0x1b, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a11, [literal for reloc index] */
603 0x0a, 0x80, 0x00, /* jx a8 */
604 0 /* unused */
605 },
606 {
607 0x18, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
608 0x1a, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
609 0x1b, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a11, [literal for reloc index] */
610 0x0a, 0x80, 0x00, /* jx a8 */
611 0 /* unused */
612 }
613 };
614
615 static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry[][PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
616 {
617 {
618 0x36, 0x41, 0x00, /* entry sp, 32 */
619 0x81, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
620 0xa1, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
621 0xb1, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a11, [literal for reloc index] */
622 0xa0, 0x08, 0x00, /* jx a8 */
623 0 /* unused */
624 },
625 {
626 0x81, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
627 0xa1, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
628 0xb1, 0x00, 0x00, /* l32r a11, [literal for reloc index] */
629 0xa0, 0x08, 0x00, /* jx a8 */
630 0 /* unused */
631 }
632 };
633
634 /* The size of the thread control block. */
635 #define TCB_SIZE 8
636
637 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry
638 {
639 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
640
641 bfd_signed_vma tlsfunc_refcount;
642
643 #define GOT_UNKNOWN 0
644 #define GOT_NORMAL 1
645 #define GOT_TLS_GD 2 /* global or local dynamic */
646 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4 /* initial or local exec */
647 #define GOT_TLS_ANY (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_IE)
648 unsigned char tls_type;
649 };
650
651 #define elf_xtensa_hash_entry(ent) ((struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *)(ent))
652
653 struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata
654 {
655 struct elf_obj_tdata root;
656
657 /* tls_type for each local got entry. */
658 char *local_got_tls_type;
659
660 bfd_signed_vma *local_tlsfunc_refcounts;
661 };
662
663 #define elf_xtensa_tdata(abfd) \
664 ((struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata *) (abfd)->tdata.any)
665
666 #define elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type(abfd) \
667 (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_got_tls_type)
668
669 #define elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts(abfd) \
670 (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_tlsfunc_refcounts)
671
672 #define is_xtensa_elf(bfd) \
673 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
674 && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
675 && elf_object_id (bfd) == XTENSA_ELF_DATA)
676
677 static bool
678 elf_xtensa_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
679 {
680 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata),
681 XTENSA_ELF_DATA);
682 }
683
684 /* Xtensa ELF linker hash table. */
685
686 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table
687 {
688 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
689
690 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
691 asection *sgotloc;
692 asection *spltlittbl;
693
694 /* Total count of PLT relocations seen during check_relocs.
695 The actual PLT code must be split into multiple sections and all
696 the sections have to be created before size_dynamic_sections,
697 where we figure out the exact number of PLT entries that will be
698 needed. It is OK if this count is an overestimate, e.g., some
699 relocations may be removed by GC. */
700 int plt_reloc_count;
701
702 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
703 };
704
705 /* Get the Xtensa ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
706
707 #define elf_xtensa_hash_table(p) \
708 ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
709 && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == XTENSA_ELF_DATA) \
710 ? (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
711
712 /* Create an entry in an Xtensa ELF linker hash table. */
713
714 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
715 elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
716 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
717 const char *string)
718 {
719 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
720 subclass. */
721 if (entry == NULL)
722 {
723 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
724 sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry));
725 if (entry == NULL)
726 return entry;
727 }
728
729 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
730 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
731 if (entry != NULL)
732 {
733 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (entry);
734 eh->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
735 eh->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
736 }
737
738 return entry;
739 }
740
741 /* Create an Xtensa ELF linker hash table. */
742
743 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
744 elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
745 {
746 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
747 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *ret;
748 size_t amt = sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table);
749
750 ret = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
751 if (ret == NULL)
752 return NULL;
753
754 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
755 elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc,
756 sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry),
757 XTENSA_ELF_DATA))
758 {
759 free (ret);
760 return NULL;
761 }
762
763 /* Create a hash entry for "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_" to speed up checking
764 for it later. */
765 tlsbase = elf_link_hash_lookup (&ret->elf, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_",
766 true, false, false);
767 tlsbase->root.type = bfd_link_hash_new;
768 tlsbase->root.u.undef.abfd = NULL;
769 tlsbase->non_elf = 0;
770 ret->elf.dt_pltgot_required = true;
771 ret->tlsbase = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (tlsbase);
772 ret->tlsbase->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
773
774 return &ret->elf.root;
775 }
776
777 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
778
779 static void
780 elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
781 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
782 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
783 {
784 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
785
786 edir = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (dir);
787 eind = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (ind);
788
789 if (ind->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
790 {
791 edir->tlsfunc_refcount += eind->tlsfunc_refcount;
792 eind->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
793
794 if (dir->got.refcount <= 0)
795 {
796 edir->tls_type = eind->tls_type;
797 eind->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
798 }
799 }
800
801 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
802 }
803
804 static inline bool
805 elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
806 struct bfd_link_info *info)
807 {
808 /* Check if we should do dynamic things to this symbol. The
809 "ignore_protected" argument need not be set, because Xtensa code
810 does not require special handling of STV_PROTECTED to make function
811 pointer comparisons work properly. The PLT addresses are never
812 used for function pointers. */
813
814 return _bfd_elf_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info, 0);
815 }
816
817 \f
818 static int
819 property_table_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
820 {
821 const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
822 const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
823
824 if (a->address == b->address)
825 {
826 if (a->size != b->size)
827 return (a->size - b->size);
828
829 if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN))
830 return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
831 - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN));
832
833 if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
834 && (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
835 != GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags)))
836 return (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
837 - GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags));
838
839 if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
840 != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
841 return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
842 - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE));
843
844 return (a->flags - b->flags);
845 }
846
847 return (a->address - b->address);
848 }
849
850
851 static int
852 property_table_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
853 {
854 const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
855 const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
856
857 /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other. */
858 if ((b->address >= a->address && b->address < (a->address + a->size))
859 || (a->address >= b->address && a->address < (b->address + b->size)))
860 return 0;
861
862 return (a->address - b->address);
863 }
864
865
866 /* Get the literal table or property table entries for the given
867 section. Sets TABLE_P and returns the number of entries. On
868 error, returns a negative value. */
869
870 int
871 xtensa_read_table_entries (bfd *abfd,
872 asection *section,
873 property_table_entry **table_p,
874 const char *sec_name,
875 bool output_addr)
876 {
877 asection *table_section;
878 bfd_size_type table_size = 0;
879 bfd_byte *table_data;
880 property_table_entry *blocks;
881 int blk, block_count;
882 bfd_size_type num_records;
883 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irel, *rel_end;
884 bfd_vma section_addr, off;
885 flagword predef_flags;
886 bfd_size_type table_entry_size, section_limit;
887
888 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
889 || !section
890 || !(section->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
891 || (section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
892 {
893 *table_p = NULL;
894 return 0;
895 }
896
897 table_section = xtensa_get_property_section (section, sec_name);
898 if (table_section)
899 table_size = table_section->size;
900
901 if (table_size == 0)
902 {
903 *table_p = NULL;
904 return 0;
905 }
906
907 predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (table_section);
908 table_entry_size = 12;
909 if (predef_flags)
910 table_entry_size -= 4;
911
912 num_records = table_size / table_entry_size;
913
914 table_data = retrieve_contents (abfd, table_section, true);
915 if (table_data == NULL)
916 {
917 *table_p = NULL;
918 return 0;
919 }
920
921 blocks = (property_table_entry *)
922 bfd_malloc (num_records * sizeof (property_table_entry));
923 block_count = 0;
924
925 if (output_addr)
926 section_addr = section->output_section->vma + section->output_offset;
927 else
928 section_addr = section->vma;
929
930 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, table_section, true);
931 if (internal_relocs && !table_section->reloc_done)
932 {
933 qsort (internal_relocs, table_section->reloc_count,
934 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_compare);
935 irel = internal_relocs;
936 }
937 else
938 irel = NULL;
939
940 section_limit = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, section);
941 rel_end = internal_relocs + table_section->reloc_count;
942
943 for (off = 0; off < table_size; off += table_entry_size)
944 {
945 bfd_vma address = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off);
946
947 /* Skip any relocations before the current offset. This should help
948 avoid confusion caused by unexpected relocations for the preceding
949 table entry. */
950 while (irel &&
951 (irel->r_offset < off
952 || (irel->r_offset == off
953 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_NONE)))
954 {
955 irel += 1;
956 if (irel >= rel_end)
957 irel = 0;
958 }
959
960 if (irel && irel->r_offset == off)
961 {
962 bfd_vma sym_off;
963 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
964 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32);
965
966 if (get_elf_r_symndx_section (abfd, r_symndx) != section)
967 continue;
968
969 sym_off = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (abfd, r_symndx);
970 BFD_ASSERT (sym_off == 0);
971 address += (section_addr + sym_off + irel->r_addend);
972 }
973 else
974 {
975 if (address < section_addr
976 || address >= section_addr + section_limit)
977 continue;
978 }
979
980 blocks[block_count].address = address;
981 blocks[block_count].size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 4);
982 if (predef_flags)
983 blocks[block_count].flags = predef_flags;
984 else
985 blocks[block_count].flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 8);
986 block_count++;
987 }
988
989 release_contents (table_section, table_data);
990 release_internal_relocs (table_section, internal_relocs);
991
992 if (block_count > 0)
993 {
994 /* Now sort them into address order for easy reference. */
995 qsort (blocks, block_count, sizeof (property_table_entry),
996 property_table_compare);
997
998 /* Check that the table contents are valid. Problems may occur,
999 for example, if an unrelocated object file is stripped. */
1000 for (blk = 1; blk < block_count; blk++)
1001 {
1002 /* The only circumstance where two entries may legitimately
1003 have the same address is when one of them is a zero-size
1004 placeholder to mark a place where fill can be inserted.
1005 The zero-size entry should come first. */
1006 if (blocks[blk - 1].address == blocks[blk].address &&
1007 blocks[blk - 1].size != 0)
1008 {
1009 /* xgettext:c-format */
1010 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB(%pA): invalid property table"),
1011 abfd, section);
1012 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
1013 free (blocks);
1014 return -1;
1015 }
1016 }
1017 }
1018
1019 *table_p = blocks;
1020 return block_count;
1021 }
1022
1023
1024 static property_table_entry *
1025 elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (property_table_entry *property_table,
1026 int property_table_size,
1027 bfd_vma addr)
1028 {
1029 property_table_entry entry;
1030 property_table_entry *rv;
1031
1032 if (property_table_size == 0)
1033 return NULL;
1034
1035 entry.address = addr;
1036 entry.size = 1;
1037 entry.flags = 0;
1038
1039 rv = bsearch (&entry, property_table, property_table_size,
1040 sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_matches);
1041 return rv;
1042 }
1043
1044
1045 static bool
1046 elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (property_table_entry *lit_table,
1047 int lit_table_size,
1048 bfd_vma addr)
1049 {
1050 if (elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (lit_table, lit_table_size, addr))
1051 return true;
1052
1053 return false;
1054 }
1055
1056 \f
1057 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
1058 calculate needed space in the dynamic reloc sections. */
1059
1060 static bool
1061 elf_xtensa_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
1062 struct bfd_link_info *info,
1063 asection *sec,
1064 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
1065 {
1066 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1067 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1068 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
1069 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
1070 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
1071
1072 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
1073 return true;
1074
1075 BFD_ASSERT (is_xtensa_elf (abfd));
1076
1077 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1078 if (htab == NULL)
1079 return false;
1080
1081 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1082 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
1083
1084 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
1085 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
1086 {
1087 unsigned int r_type;
1088 unsigned r_symndx;
1089 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
1090 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh;
1091 int tls_type, old_tls_type;
1092 bool is_got = false;
1093 bool is_plt = false;
1094 bool is_tlsfunc = false;
1095
1096 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
1097 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
1098
1099 if (r_symndx >= NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
1100 {
1101 /* xgettext:c-format */
1102 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: bad symbol index: %d"),
1103 abfd, r_symndx);
1104 return false;
1105 }
1106
1107 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1108 {
1109 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1110 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1111 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1112 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1113 }
1114 eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1115
1116 switch (r_type)
1117 {
1118 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1119 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1120 {
1121 tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1122 is_got = true;
1123 is_tlsfunc = true;
1124 }
1125 else
1126 tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1127 break;
1128
1129 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1130 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1131 {
1132 tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1133 is_got = true;
1134 }
1135 else
1136 {
1137 tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1138 if (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) != htab->tlsbase)
1139 is_got = true;
1140 }
1141 break;
1142
1143 case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
1144 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1145 tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1146 else
1147 tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1148 break;
1149
1150 case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1151 tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1152 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1153 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
1154 if (bfd_link_pic (info) || h)
1155 is_got = true;
1156 break;
1157
1158 case R_XTENSA_32:
1159 tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1160 is_got = true;
1161 break;
1162
1163 case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1164 tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1165 is_plt = true;
1166 break;
1167
1168 case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1169 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
1170 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
1171 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
1172 return false;
1173 continue;
1174
1175 case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1176 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
1177 used. Record for later use during GC. */
1178 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
1179 return false;
1180 continue;
1181
1182 default:
1183 /* Nothing to do for any other relocations. */
1184 continue;
1185 }
1186
1187 if (h)
1188 {
1189 if (is_plt)
1190 {
1191 if (h->plt.refcount <= 0)
1192 {
1193 h->needs_plt = 1;
1194 h->plt.refcount = 1;
1195 }
1196 else
1197 h->plt.refcount += 1;
1198
1199 /* Keep track of the total PLT relocation count even if we
1200 don't yet know whether the dynamic sections will be
1201 created. */
1202 htab->plt_reloc_count += 1;
1203
1204 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1205 {
1206 if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1207 return false;
1208 }
1209 }
1210 else if (is_got)
1211 {
1212 if (h->got.refcount <= 0)
1213 h->got.refcount = 1;
1214 else
1215 h->got.refcount += 1;
1216 }
1217
1218 if (is_tlsfunc)
1219 eh->tlsfunc_refcount += 1;
1220
1221 old_tls_type = eh->tls_type;
1222 }
1223 else
1224 {
1225 /* Allocate storage the first time. */
1226 if (elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) == NULL)
1227 {
1228 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1229 void *mem;
1230
1231 mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1232 if (mem == NULL)
1233 return false;
1234 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1235
1236 mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
1237 if (mem == NULL)
1238 return false;
1239 elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) = (char *) mem;
1240
1241 mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1242 if (mem == NULL)
1243 return false;
1244 elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd)
1245 = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1246 }
1247
1248 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
1249 if (is_got || is_plt)
1250 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1251
1252 if (is_tlsfunc)
1253 elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1254
1255 old_tls_type = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx];
1256 }
1257
1258 if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
1259 tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1260 /* If a TLS symbol is accessed using IE at least once,
1261 there is no point to use a dynamic model for it. */
1262 else if (old_tls_type != tls_type && old_tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN
1263 && ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) == 0
1264 || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) == 0))
1265 {
1266 if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1267 tls_type = old_tls_type;
1268 else if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1269 tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1270 else
1271 {
1272 _bfd_error_handler
1273 /* xgettext:c-format */
1274 (_("%pB: `%s' accessed both as normal and thread local symbol"),
1275 abfd,
1276 h ? h->root.root.string : "<local>");
1277 return false;
1278 }
1279 }
1280
1281 if (old_tls_type != tls_type)
1282 {
1283 if (eh)
1284 eh->tls_type = tls_type;
1285 else
1286 elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx] = tls_type;
1287 }
1288 }
1289
1290 return true;
1291 }
1292
1293
1294 static void
1295 elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1296 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1297 {
1298 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1299 {
1300 if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1301 {
1302 /* For shared objects, there's no need for PLT entries for local
1303 symbols (use RELATIVE relocs instead of JMP_SLOT relocs). */
1304 if (h->got.refcount < 0)
1305 h->got.refcount = 0;
1306 h->got.refcount += h->plt.refcount;
1307 h->plt.refcount = 0;
1308 }
1309 }
1310 else
1311 {
1312 /* Don't need any dynamic relocations at all. */
1313 h->plt.refcount = 0;
1314 h->got.refcount = 0;
1315 }
1316 }
1317
1318
1319 static void
1320 elf_xtensa_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1321 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1322 bool force_local)
1323 {
1324 /* For a shared link, move the plt refcount to the got refcount to leave
1325 space for RELATIVE relocs. */
1326 elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1327
1328 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
1329 }
1330
1331
1332 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
1333 relocation. */
1334
1335 static asection *
1336 elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
1337 struct bfd_link_info *info,
1338 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
1339 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1340 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
1341 {
1342 /* Property sections are marked "KEEP" in the linker scripts, but they
1343 should not cause other sections to be marked. (This approach relies
1344 on elf_xtensa_discard_info to remove property table entries that
1345 describe discarded sections. Alternatively, it might be more
1346 efficient to avoid using "KEEP" in the linker scripts and instead use
1347 the gc_mark_extra_sections hook to mark only the property sections
1348 that describe marked sections. That alternative does not work well
1349 with the current property table sections, which do not correspond
1350 one-to-one with the sections they describe, but that should be fixed
1351 someday.) */
1352 if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
1353 return NULL;
1354
1355 if (h != NULL)
1356 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
1357 {
1358 case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1359 case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1360 return NULL;
1361 }
1362
1363 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
1364 }
1365
1366
1367 /* Create all the dynamic sections. */
1368
1369 static bool
1370 elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
1371 {
1372 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1373 flagword flags, noalloc_flags;
1374
1375 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1376 if (htab == NULL)
1377 return false;
1378
1379 /* First do all the standard stuff. */
1380 if (! _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info))
1381 return false;
1382
1383 /* Create any extra PLT sections in case check_relocs has already
1384 been called on all the non-dynamic input files. */
1385 if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1386 return false;
1387
1388 noalloc_flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1389 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1390 flags = noalloc_flags | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD;
1391
1392 /* Mark the ".got.plt" section READONLY. */
1393 if (htab->elf.sgotplt == NULL
1394 || !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgotplt, flags))
1395 return false;
1396
1397 /* Create ".got.loc" (literal tables for use by dynamic linker). */
1398 htab->sgotloc = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".got.loc",
1399 flags);
1400 if (htab->sgotloc == NULL
1401 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->sgotloc, 2))
1402 return false;
1403
1404 /* Create ".xt.lit.plt" (literal table for ".got.plt*"). */
1405 htab->spltlittbl = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, ".xt.lit.plt",
1406 noalloc_flags);
1407 if (htab->spltlittbl == NULL
1408 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->spltlittbl, 2))
1409 return false;
1410
1411 return true;
1412 }
1413
1414
1415 static bool
1416 add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info, int count)
1417 {
1418 bfd *dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1419 int chunk;
1420
1421 /* Iterate over all chunks except 0 which uses the standard ".plt" and
1422 ".got.plt" sections. */
1423 for (chunk = count / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK; chunk > 0; chunk--)
1424 {
1425 char *sname;
1426 flagword flags;
1427 asection *s;
1428
1429 /* Stop when we find a section has already been created. */
1430 if (elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk))
1431 break;
1432
1433 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1434 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1435
1436 sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (10);
1437 sprintf (sname, ".plt.%u", chunk);
1438 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags | SEC_CODE);
1439 if (s == NULL
1440 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
1441 return false;
1442
1443 sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (14);
1444 sprintf (sname, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
1445 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags);
1446 if (s == NULL
1447 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
1448 return false;
1449 }
1450
1451 return true;
1452 }
1453
1454
1455 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
1456 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
1457 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
1458 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
1459 understand. */
1460
1461 static bool
1462 elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1463 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1464 {
1465 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
1466 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
1467 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
1468 if (h->is_weakalias)
1469 {
1470 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
1471 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
1472 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
1473 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
1474 return true;
1475 }
1476
1477 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object. The
1478 reference must go through the GOT, so there's no need for COPY relocs,
1479 .dynbss, etc. */
1480
1481 return true;
1482 }
1483
1484
1485 static bool
1486 elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *arg)
1487 {
1488 struct bfd_link_info *info;
1489 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1490 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1491
1492 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1493 return true;
1494
1495 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) arg;
1496 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1497 if (htab == NULL)
1498 return false;
1499
1500 /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can then optimize
1501 away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs. */
1502 if ((eh->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1503 {
1504 BFD_ASSERT (h->got.refcount >= eh->tlsfunc_refcount);
1505 h->got.refcount -= eh->tlsfunc_refcount;
1506 }
1507
1508 if (! elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info))
1509 elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1510
1511 if (! elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info)
1512 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1513 return true;
1514
1515 if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1516 htab->elf.srelplt->size += (h->plt.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1517
1518 if (h->got.refcount > 0)
1519 htab->elf.srelgot->size += (h->got.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1520
1521 return true;
1522 }
1523
1524
1525 static void
1526 elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1527 {
1528 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1529 bfd *i;
1530
1531 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1532 if (htab == NULL)
1533 return;
1534
1535 for (i = info->input_bfds; i; i = i->link.next)
1536 {
1537 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
1538 bfd_size_type j, cnt;
1539 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1540
1541 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (i);
1542 if (!local_got_refcounts)
1543 continue;
1544
1545 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (i)->symtab_hdr;
1546 cnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1547
1548 for (j = 0; j < cnt; ++j)
1549 {
1550 /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can
1551 then optimize away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs. */
1552 if ((elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (i) [j] & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1553 {
1554 bfd_signed_vma *tlsfunc_refcount
1555 = &elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (i) [j];
1556 BFD_ASSERT (local_got_refcounts[j] >= *tlsfunc_refcount);
1557 local_got_refcounts[j] -= *tlsfunc_refcount;
1558 }
1559
1560 if (local_got_refcounts[j] > 0)
1561 htab->elf.srelgot->size += (local_got_refcounts[j]
1562 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1563 }
1564 }
1565 }
1566
1567
1568 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
1569
1570 static bool
1571 elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1572 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1573 {
1574 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1575 bfd *dynobj, *abfd;
1576 asection *s, *srelplt, *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot, *spltlittbl, *sgotloc;
1577 bool relplt, relgot;
1578 int plt_entries, plt_chunks, chunk;
1579
1580 plt_entries = 0;
1581 plt_chunks = 0;
1582
1583 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1584 if (htab == NULL)
1585 return false;
1586
1587 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1588 if (dynobj == NULL)
1589 abort ();
1590 srelgot = htab->elf.srelgot;
1591 srelplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
1592
1593 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1594 {
1595 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.srelgot != NULL
1596 && htab->elf.srelplt != NULL
1597 && htab->elf.sgot != NULL
1598 && htab->spltlittbl != NULL
1599 && htab->sgotloc != NULL);
1600
1601 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
1602 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
1603 {
1604 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
1605 if (s == NULL)
1606 abort ();
1607 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1608 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1609 }
1610
1611 /* Allocate room for one word in ".got". */
1612 htab->elf.sgot->size = 4;
1613
1614 /* Allocate space in ".rela.got" for literals that reference global
1615 symbols and space in ".rela.plt" for literals that have PLT
1616 entries. */
1617 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
1618 elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs,
1619 (void *) info);
1620
1621 /* If we are generating a shared object, we also need space in
1622 ".rela.got" for R_XTENSA_RELATIVE relocs for literals that
1623 reference local symbols. */
1624 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
1625 elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (info);
1626
1627 /* Allocate space in ".plt" to match the size of ".rela.plt". For
1628 each PLT entry, we need the PLT code plus a 4-byte literal.
1629 For each chunk of ".plt", we also need two more 4-byte
1630 literals, two corresponding entries in ".rela.got", and an
1631 8-byte entry in ".xt.lit.plt". */
1632 spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
1633 plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1634 plt_chunks =
1635 (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1636
1637 /* Iterate over all the PLT chunks, including any extra sections
1638 created earlier because the initial count of PLT relocations
1639 was an overestimate. */
1640 for (chunk = 0;
1641 (splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk)) != NULL;
1642 chunk++)
1643 {
1644 int chunk_entries;
1645
1646 sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
1647 BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
1648
1649 if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
1650 chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1651 else if (chunk == plt_chunks - 1)
1652 chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
1653 else
1654 chunk_entries = 0;
1655
1656 if (chunk_entries != 0)
1657 {
1658 sgotplt->size = 4 * (chunk_entries + 2);
1659 splt->size = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE * chunk_entries;
1660 srelgot->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1661 spltlittbl->size += 8;
1662 }
1663 else
1664 {
1665 sgotplt->size = 0;
1666 splt->size = 0;
1667 }
1668 }
1669
1670 /* Allocate space in ".got.loc" to match the total size of all the
1671 literal tables. */
1672 sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
1673 sgotloc->size = spltlittbl->size;
1674 for (abfd = info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
1675 {
1676 if (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC)
1677 continue;
1678 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1679 {
1680 if (! discarded_section (s)
1681 && xtensa_is_littable_section (s)
1682 && s != spltlittbl)
1683 sgotloc->size += s->size;
1684 }
1685 }
1686 }
1687
1688 /* Allocate memory for dynamic sections. */
1689 relplt = false;
1690 relgot = false;
1691 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1692 {
1693 const char *name;
1694
1695 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
1696 continue;
1697
1698 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
1699 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
1700 name = bfd_section_name (s);
1701
1702 if (startswith (name, ".rela"))
1703 {
1704 if (s->size != 0)
1705 {
1706 if (strcmp (name, ".rela.plt") == 0)
1707 relplt = true;
1708 else if (strcmp (name, ".rela.got") == 0)
1709 relgot = true;
1710
1711 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
1712 to copy relocs into the output file. */
1713 s->reloc_count = 0;
1714 }
1715 }
1716 else if (! startswith (name, ".plt.")
1717 && ! startswith (name, ".got.plt.")
1718 && strcmp (name, ".got") != 0
1719 && strcmp (name, ".plt") != 0
1720 && strcmp (name, ".got.plt") != 0
1721 && strcmp (name, ".xt.lit.plt") != 0
1722 && strcmp (name, ".got.loc") != 0)
1723 {
1724 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
1725 continue;
1726 }
1727
1728 if (s->size == 0)
1729 {
1730 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the output
1731 file. We must create the ".plt*" and ".got.plt*"
1732 sections in create_dynamic_sections and/or check_relocs
1733 based on a conservative estimate of the PLT relocation
1734 count, because the sections must be created before the
1735 linker maps input sections to output sections. The
1736 linker does that before size_dynamic_sections, where we
1737 compute the exact size of the PLT, so there may be more
1738 of these sections than are actually needed. */
1739 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1740 }
1741 else if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
1742 {
1743 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
1744 s->contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
1745 if (s->contents == NULL)
1746 return false;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1751 {
1752 /* Add the special XTENSA_RTLD relocations now. The offsets won't be
1753 known until finish_dynamic_sections, but we need to get the relocs
1754 in place before they are sorted. */
1755 for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
1756 {
1757 Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
1758 bfd_byte *loc;
1759
1760 irela.r_offset = 0;
1761 irela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RTLD);
1762 irela.r_addend = 0;
1763
1764 loc = (srelgot->contents
1765 + srelgot->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1766 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
1767 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela,
1768 loc + sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1769 srelgot->reloc_count += 2;
1770 }
1771
1772 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
1773 values later, in elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
1774 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
1775 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
1776 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
1777 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
1778 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
1779
1780 if (!_bfd_elf_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
1781 relplt || relgot))
1782 return false;
1783
1784 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF, 0)
1785 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ, 0))
1786 return false;
1787 }
1788 #undef add_dynamic_entry
1789
1790 return true;
1791 }
1792
1793 static bool
1794 elf_xtensa_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
1795 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1796 {
1797 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1798 asection *tls_sec;
1799
1800 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1801 if (htab == NULL)
1802 return false;
1803
1804 tls_sec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
1805
1806 if (tls_sec && (htab->tlsbase->tls_type & GOT_TLS_ANY) != 0)
1807 {
1808 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase = &htab->tlsbase->elf;
1809 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = &tlsbase->root;
1810 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
1811
1812 tlsbase->type = STT_TLS;
1813 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
1814 (info, output_bfd, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", BSF_LOCAL,
1815 tls_sec, 0, NULL, false,
1816 bed->collect, &bh)))
1817 return false;
1818 tlsbase->def_regular = 1;
1819 tlsbase->other = STV_HIDDEN;
1820 (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (info, tlsbase, true);
1821 }
1822
1823 return true;
1824 }
1825
1826 \f
1827 /* Return the base VMA address which should be subtracted from real addresses
1828 when resolving @dtpoff relocation.
1829 This is PT_TLS segment p_vaddr. */
1830
1831 static bfd_vma
1832 dtpoff_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1833 {
1834 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1835 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1836 return 0;
1837 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma;
1838 }
1839
1840 /* Return the relocation value for @tpoff relocation
1841 if STT_TLS virtual address is ADDRESS. */
1842
1843 static bfd_vma
1844 tpoff (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_vma address)
1845 {
1846 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
1847 bfd_vma base;
1848
1849 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1850 if (htab->tls_sec == NULL)
1851 return 0;
1852 base = align_power ((bfd_vma) TCB_SIZE, htab->tls_sec->alignment_power);
1853 return address - htab->tls_sec->vma + base;
1854 }
1855
1856 /* Perform the specified relocation. The instruction at (contents + address)
1857 is modified to set one operand to represent the value in "relocation". The
1858 operand position is determined by the relocation type recorded in the
1859 howto. */
1860
1861 #define CALL_SEGMENT_BITS (30)
1862 #define CALL_SEGMENT_SIZE (1 << CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1863
1864 static bfd_reloc_status_type
1865 elf_xtensa_do_reloc (reloc_howto_type *howto,
1866 bfd *abfd,
1867 asection *input_section,
1868 bfd_vma relocation,
1869 bfd_byte *contents,
1870 bfd_vma address,
1871 bool is_weak_undef,
1872 char **error_message)
1873 {
1874 xtensa_format fmt;
1875 xtensa_opcode opcode;
1876 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
1877 static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
1878 static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
1879 bfd_vma self_address;
1880 bfd_size_type input_size;
1881 int opnd, slot;
1882 uint32 newval;
1883
1884 if (!ibuff)
1885 {
1886 ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1887 sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1888 }
1889
1890 input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
1891
1892 /* Calculate the PC address for this instruction. */
1893 self_address = (input_section->output_section->vma
1894 + input_section->output_offset
1895 + address);
1896
1897 switch (howto->type)
1898 {
1899 case R_XTENSA_NONE:
1900 case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
1901 case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
1902 case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
1903 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF8:
1904 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF16:
1905 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF32:
1906 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF8:
1907 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF16:
1908 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF32:
1909 case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
1910 case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
1911 case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
1912 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1913
1914 case R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
1915 if (!is_weak_undef)
1916 {
1917 /* Check for windowed CALL across a 1GB boundary. */
1918 opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + address,
1919 input_size - address, 0);
1920 if (is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
1921 {
1922 if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1923 != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
1924 {
1925 *error_message = "windowed longcall crosses 1GB boundary; "
1926 "return may fail";
1927 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1928 }
1929 }
1930 }
1931 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1932
1933 case R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
1934 {
1935 /* Convert the L32R/CALLX to CALL. */
1936 bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
1937 elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, address, input_size,
1938 error_message);
1939 if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
1940 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1941
1942 /* The CALL needs to be relocated. Continue below for that part. */
1943 address += 3;
1944 self_address += 3;
1945 howto = &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP ];
1946 }
1947 break;
1948
1949 case R_XTENSA_32:
1950 {
1951 bfd_vma x;
1952 x = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + address);
1953 x = x + relocation;
1954 bfd_put_32 (abfd, x, contents + address);
1955 }
1956 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1957
1958 case R_XTENSA_32_PCREL:
1959 bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation - self_address, contents + address);
1960 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1961
1962 case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1963 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1964 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1965 case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
1966 case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1967 bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation, contents + address);
1968 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1969 }
1970
1971 /* Only instruction slot-specific relocations handled below.... */
1972 slot = get_relocation_slot (howto->type);
1973 if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
1974 {
1975 *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
1976 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1977 }
1978
1979 if (input_size <= address)
1980 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1981 /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode. */
1982 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
1983 input_size - address);
1984 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
1985 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
1986 {
1987 *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
1988 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1989 }
1990
1991 xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
1992
1993 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
1994 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
1995 {
1996 *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
1997 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1998 }
1999
2000 /* Check for opcode-specific "alternate" relocations. */
2001 if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2002 {
2003 if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2004 {
2005 /* Handle the special-case of non-PC-relative L32R instructions. */
2006 bfd *output_bfd = input_section->output_section->owner;
2007 asection *lit4_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".lit4");
2008 if (!lit4_sec)
2009 {
2010 *error_message = "relocation references missing .lit4 section";
2011 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2012 }
2013 self_address = ((lit4_sec->vma & ~0xfff)
2014 + 0x40000 - 3); /* -3 to compensate for do_reloc */
2015 newval = relocation;
2016 opnd = 1;
2017 }
2018 else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2019 {
2020 /* ALT used for high 16 bits.
2021 Ignore 32-bit overflow. */
2022 newval = (relocation >> 16) & 0xffff;
2023 opnd = 1;
2024 }
2025 else
2026 {
2027 /* No other "alternate" relocations currently defined. */
2028 *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2029 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2030 }
2031 }
2032 else /* Not an "alternate" relocation.... */
2033 {
2034 if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2035 {
2036 newval = relocation & 0xffff;
2037 opnd = 1;
2038 }
2039 else
2040 {
2041 /* ...normal PC-relative relocation.... */
2042
2043 /* Determine which operand is being relocated. */
2044 opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, howto->type);
2045 if (opnd == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2046 {
2047 *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2048 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2049 }
2050
2051 if (!howto->pc_relative)
2052 {
2053 *error_message = "expected PC-relative relocation";
2054 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2055 }
2056
2057 newval = relocation;
2058 }
2059 }
2060
2061 /* Apply the relocation. */
2062 if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval, self_address)
2063 || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval)
2064 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opnd, fmt, slot,
2065 sbuff, newval))
2066 {
2067 const char *opname = xtensa_opcode_name (isa, opcode);
2068 const char *msg;
2069
2070 msg = "cannot encode";
2071 if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode))
2072 {
2073 if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2074 msg = "misaligned call target";
2075 else
2076 msg = "call target out of range";
2077 }
2078 else if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2079 {
2080 if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2081 msg = "misaligned literal target";
2082 else if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2083 msg = "literal target out of range (too many literals)";
2084 else if (self_address > relocation)
2085 msg = "literal target out of range (try using text-section-literals)";
2086 else
2087 msg = "literal placed after use";
2088 }
2089
2090 *error_message = vsprint_msg (opname, ": %s", strlen (msg) + 2, msg);
2091 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2092 }
2093
2094 /* Check for calls across 1GB boundaries. */
2095 if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode)
2096 && is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
2097 {
2098 if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
2099 != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
2100 {
2101 *error_message =
2102 "windowed call crosses 1GB boundary; return may fail";
2103 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2104 }
2105 }
2106
2107 /* Write the modified instruction back out of the buffer. */
2108 xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
2109 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
2110 input_size - address);
2111 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2112 }
2113
2114
2115 static char *
2116 vsprint_msg (const char *origmsg, const char *fmt, int arglen, ...)
2117 {
2118 /* To reduce the size of the memory leak,
2119 we only use a single message buffer. */
2120 static bfd_size_type alloc_size = 0;
2121 static char *message = NULL;
2122 bfd_size_type orig_len, len = 0;
2123 bool is_append;
2124 va_list ap;
2125
2126 va_start (ap, arglen);
2127
2128 is_append = (origmsg == message);
2129
2130 orig_len = strlen (origmsg);
2131 len = orig_len + strlen (fmt) + arglen + 20;
2132 if (len > alloc_size)
2133 {
2134 message = (char *) bfd_realloc_or_free (message, len);
2135 alloc_size = len;
2136 }
2137 if (message != NULL)
2138 {
2139 if (!is_append)
2140 memcpy (message, origmsg, orig_len);
2141 vsprintf (message + orig_len, fmt, ap);
2142 }
2143 va_end (ap);
2144 return message;
2145 }
2146
2147
2148 /* This function is registered as the "special_function" in the
2149 Xtensa howto for handling simplify operations.
2150 bfd_perform_relocation / bfd_install_relocation use it to
2151 perform (install) the specified relocation. Since this replaces the code
2152 in bfd_perform_relocation, it is basically an Xtensa-specific,
2153 stripped-down version of bfd_perform_relocation. */
2154
2155 static bfd_reloc_status_type
2156 bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc (bfd *abfd,
2157 arelent *reloc_entry,
2158 asymbol *symbol,
2159 void *data,
2160 asection *input_section,
2161 bfd *output_bfd,
2162 char **error_message)
2163 {
2164 bfd_vma relocation;
2165 bfd_reloc_status_type flag;
2166 bfd_size_type octets = (reloc_entry->address
2167 * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section));
2168 bfd_vma output_base = 0;
2169 reloc_howto_type *howto = reloc_entry->howto;
2170 asection *reloc_target_output_section;
2171 bool is_weak_undef;
2172
2173 if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2174 xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2175
2176 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
2177 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, the resulting
2178 reloc will also be against the same symbol. In such a case, we
2179 don't want to change anything about the way the reloc is handled,
2180 since it will all be done at final link time. This test is similar
2181 to what bfd_elf_generic_reloc does except that it lets relocs with
2182 howto->partial_inplace go through even if the addend is non-zero.
2183 (The real problem is that partial_inplace is set for XTENSA_32
2184 relocs to begin with, but that's a long story and there's little we
2185 can do about it now....) */
2186
2187 if (output_bfd && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2188 {
2189 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2190 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2191 }
2192
2193 /* Is the address of the relocation really within the section? */
2194 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2195 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2196
2197 /* Work out which section the relocation is targeted at and the
2198 initial relocation command value. */
2199
2200 /* Get symbol value. (Common symbols are special.) */
2201 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2202 relocation = 0;
2203 else
2204 relocation = symbol->value;
2205
2206 reloc_target_output_section = symbol->section->output_section;
2207
2208 /* Convert input-section-relative symbol value to absolute. */
2209 if ((output_bfd && !howto->partial_inplace)
2210 || reloc_target_output_section == NULL)
2211 output_base = 0;
2212 else
2213 output_base = reloc_target_output_section->vma;
2214
2215 relocation += output_base + symbol->section->output_offset;
2216
2217 /* Add in supplied addend. */
2218 relocation += reloc_entry->addend;
2219
2220 /* Here the variable relocation holds the final address of the
2221 symbol we are relocating against, plus any addend. */
2222 if (output_bfd)
2223 {
2224 if (!howto->partial_inplace)
2225 {
2226 /* This is a partial relocation, and we want to apply the relocation
2227 to the reloc entry rather than the raw data. Everything except
2228 relocations against section symbols has already been handled
2229 above. */
2230
2231 BFD_ASSERT (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM);
2232 reloc_entry->addend = relocation;
2233 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2234 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2235 }
2236 else
2237 {
2238 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2239 reloc_entry->addend = 0;
2240 }
2241 }
2242
2243 is_weak_undef = (bfd_is_und_section (symbol->section)
2244 && (symbol->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0);
2245 flag = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, abfd, input_section, relocation,
2246 (bfd_byte *) data, (bfd_vma) octets,
2247 is_weak_undef, error_message);
2248
2249 if (flag == bfd_reloc_dangerous)
2250 {
2251 /* Add the symbol name to the error message. */
2252 if (! *error_message)
2253 *error_message = "";
2254 *error_message = vsprint_msg (*error_message, ": (%s + 0x%lx)",
2255 strlen (symbol->name) + 17,
2256 symbol->name,
2257 (unsigned long) reloc_entry->addend);
2258 }
2259
2260 return flag;
2261 }
2262
2263 int xtensa_abi_choice (void)
2264 {
2265 if (elf32xtensa_abi == XTHAL_ABI_UNDEFINED)
2266 return XSHAL_ABI;
2267 else
2268 return elf32xtensa_abi;
2269 }
2270
2271 /* Set up an entry in the procedure linkage table. */
2272
2273 static bfd_vma
2274 elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2275 bfd *output_bfd,
2276 unsigned reloc_index)
2277 {
2278 asection *splt, *sgotplt;
2279 bfd_vma plt_base, got_base;
2280 bfd_vma code_offset, lit_offset, abi_offset;
2281 int chunk;
2282 int abi = xtensa_abi_choice ();
2283
2284 chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
2285 splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
2286 sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
2287 BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
2288
2289 plt_base = splt->output_section->vma + splt->output_offset;
2290 got_base = sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset;
2291
2292 lit_offset = 8 + (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * 4;
2293 code_offset = (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
2294
2295 /* Fill in the literal entry. This is the offset of the dynamic
2296 relocation entry. */
2297 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela),
2298 sgotplt->contents + lit_offset);
2299
2300 /* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table. */
2301 memcpy (splt->contents + code_offset,
2302 (bfd_big_endian (output_bfd)
2303 ? elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry[abi != XTHAL_ABI_WINDOWED]
2304 : elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry[abi != XTHAL_ABI_WINDOWED]),
2305 PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
2306 abi_offset = abi == XTHAL_ABI_WINDOWED ? 3 : 0;
2307 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 0,
2308 plt_base + code_offset + abi_offset),
2309 splt->contents + code_offset + abi_offset + 1);
2310 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 4,
2311 plt_base + code_offset + abi_offset + 3),
2312 splt->contents + code_offset + abi_offset + 4);
2313 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + lit_offset,
2314 plt_base + code_offset + abi_offset + 6),
2315 splt->contents + code_offset + abi_offset + 7);
2316
2317 return plt_base + code_offset;
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 static bool get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode, unsigned *);
2322
2323 static bool
2324 replace_tls_insn (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
2325 bfd *abfd,
2326 asection *input_section,
2327 bfd_byte *contents,
2328 bool is_ld_model,
2329 char **error_message)
2330 {
2331 static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
2332 static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
2333 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
2334 xtensa_format fmt;
2335 xtensa_opcode old_op, new_op;
2336 bfd_size_type input_size;
2337 int r_type;
2338 unsigned dest_reg, src_reg;
2339
2340 if (ibuff == NULL)
2341 {
2342 ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2343 sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2344 }
2345
2346 input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
2347
2348 /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode. */
2349 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2350 input_size - rel->r_offset);
2351 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
2352 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2353 {
2354 *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
2355 return false;
2356 }
2357
2358 BFD_ASSERT (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1);
2359 xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2360
2361 old_op = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff);
2362 if (old_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2363 {
2364 *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
2365 return false;
2366 }
2367
2368 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2369 switch (r_type)
2370 {
2371 case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2372 case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2373 if (old_op != get_l32r_opcode ()
2374 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2375 sbuff, &dest_reg) != 0)
2376 {
2377 *error_message = "cannot extract L32R destination for TLS access";
2378 return false;
2379 }
2380 break;
2381
2382 case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2383 if (! get_indirect_call_dest_reg (old_op, &dest_reg)
2384 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2385 sbuff, &src_reg) != 0)
2386 {
2387 *error_message = "cannot extract CALLXn operands for TLS access";
2388 return false;
2389 }
2390 break;
2391
2392 default:
2393 abort ();
2394 }
2395
2396 if (is_ld_model)
2397 {
2398 switch (r_type)
2399 {
2400 case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2401 case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2402 /* Change the instruction to a NOP (or "OR a1, a1, a1" for older
2403 versions of Xtensa). */
2404 new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "nop");
2405 if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2406 {
2407 new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
2408 if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2409 || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2410 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2411 sbuff, 1) != 0
2412 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2413 sbuff, 1) != 0
2414 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2415 sbuff, 1) != 0)
2416 {
2417 *error_message = "cannot encode OR for TLS access";
2418 return false;
2419 }
2420 }
2421 else
2422 {
2423 if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0)
2424 {
2425 *error_message = "cannot encode NOP for TLS access";
2426 return false;
2427 }
2428 }
2429 break;
2430
2431 case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2432 /* Read THREADPTR into the CALLX's return value register. */
2433 new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2434 if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2435 || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2436 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2437 sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0)
2438 {
2439 *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2440 return false;
2441 }
2442 break;
2443 }
2444 }
2445 else
2446 {
2447 switch (r_type)
2448 {
2449 case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2450 new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2451 if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2452 || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2453 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2454 sbuff, dest_reg) != 0)
2455 {
2456 *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2457 return false;
2458 }
2459 break;
2460
2461 case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2462 /* Nothing to do. Keep the original L32R instruction. */
2463 return true;
2464
2465 case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2466 /* Add the CALLX's src register (holding the THREADPTR value)
2467 to the first argument register (holding the offset) and put
2468 the result in the CALLX's return value register. */
2469 new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "add");
2470 if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2471 || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2472 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2473 sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2474 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2475 sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2476 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2477 sbuff, src_reg) != 0)
2478 {
2479 *error_message = "cannot encode ADD for TLS access";
2480 return false;
2481 }
2482 break;
2483 }
2484 }
2485
2486 xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2487 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2488 input_size - rel->r_offset);
2489
2490 return true;
2491 }
2492
2493
2494 #define IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC(R_TYPE) \
2495 ((R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN \
2496 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG \
2497 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF \
2498 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF \
2499 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC \
2500 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG \
2501 || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL)
2502
2503 /* Relocate an Xtensa ELF section. This is invoked by the linker for
2504 both relocatable and final links. */
2505
2506 static int
2507 elf_xtensa_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
2508 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2509 bfd *input_bfd,
2510 asection *input_section,
2511 bfd_byte *contents,
2512 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
2513 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
2514 asection **local_sections)
2515 {
2516 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
2517 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2518 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2519 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
2520 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2521 property_table_entry *lit_table = 0;
2522 int ltblsize = 0;
2523 char *local_got_tls_types;
2524 char *error_message = NULL;
2525 bfd_size_type input_size;
2526 int tls_type;
2527
2528 if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2529 xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2530
2531 if (!is_xtensa_elf (input_bfd))
2532 {
2533 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
2534 return false;
2535 }
2536
2537 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
2538 if (htab == NULL)
2539 return false;
2540
2541 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
2542 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
2543 local_got_tls_types = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd);
2544
2545 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2546 {
2547 ltblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (input_bfd, input_section,
2548 &lit_table, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME,
2549 true);
2550 if (ltblsize < 0)
2551 return false;
2552 }
2553
2554 input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section);
2555
2556 rel = relocs;
2557 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
2558 for (; rel < relend; rel++)
2559 {
2560 int r_type;
2561 reloc_howto_type *howto;
2562 unsigned long r_symndx;
2563 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2564 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
2565 char sym_type;
2566 const char *name;
2567 asection *sec;
2568 bfd_vma relocation;
2569 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
2570 bool is_weak_undef;
2571 bool unresolved_reloc;
2572 bool warned;
2573 bool dynamic_symbol;
2574
2575 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2576 if (r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT
2577 || r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY)
2578 continue;
2579
2580 if (r_type < 0 || r_type >= (int) R_XTENSA_max)
2581 {
2582 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2583 return false;
2584 }
2585 howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2586
2587 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2588
2589 h = NULL;
2590 sym = NULL;
2591 sec = NULL;
2592 is_weak_undef = false;
2593 unresolved_reloc = false;
2594 warned = false;
2595
2596 if (howto->partial_inplace && !bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2597 {
2598 /* Because R_XTENSA_32 was made partial_inplace to fix some
2599 problems with DWARF info in partial links, there may be
2600 an addend stored in the contents. Take it out of there
2601 and move it back into the addend field of the reloc. */
2602 rel->r_addend += bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
2603 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0, contents + rel->r_offset);
2604 }
2605
2606 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2607 {
2608 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2609 sym_type = ELF32_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
2610 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2611 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
2612 }
2613 else
2614 {
2615 bool ignored;
2616
2617 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
2618 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
2619 h, sec, relocation,
2620 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
2621
2622 if (relocation == 0
2623 && !unresolved_reloc
2624 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2625 is_weak_undef = true;
2626
2627 sym_type = h->type;
2628 }
2629
2630 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
2631 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
2632 rel, 1, relend, howto, 0, contents);
2633
2634 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2635 {
2636 bfd_vma dest_addr;
2637 asection * sym_sec = get_elf_r_symndx_section (input_bfd, r_symndx);
2638
2639 /* This is a relocatable link.
2640 1) If the reloc is against a section symbol, adjust
2641 according to the output section.
2642 2) If there is a new target for this relocation,
2643 the new target will be in the same output section.
2644 We adjust the relocation by the output section
2645 difference. */
2646
2647 if (relaxing_section)
2648 {
2649 /* Check if this references a section in another input file. */
2650 if (!do_fix_for_relocatable_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section,
2651 contents))
2652 return false;
2653 }
2654
2655 dest_addr = sym_sec->output_section->vma + sym_sec->output_offset
2656 + get_elf_r_symndx_offset (input_bfd, r_symndx) + rel->r_addend;
2657
2658 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
2659 {
2660 error_message = NULL;
2661 /* Convert ASM_SIMPLIFY into the simpler relocation
2662 so that they never escape a relaxing link. */
2663 r = contract_asm_expansion (contents, input_size, rel,
2664 &error_message);
2665 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2666 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2667 (info, error_message,
2668 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2669
2670 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2671 }
2672
2673 /* This is a relocatable link, so we don't have to change
2674 anything unless the reloc is against a section symbol,
2675 in which case we have to adjust according to where the
2676 section symbol winds up in the output section. */
2677 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2678 {
2679 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2680 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
2681 {
2682 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2683 rel->r_addend += sec->output_offset + sym->st_value;
2684 }
2685 }
2686
2687 /* If there is an addend with a partial_inplace howto,
2688 then move the addend to the contents. This is a hack
2689 to work around problems with DWARF in relocatable links
2690 with some previous version of BFD. Now we can't easily get
2691 rid of the hack without breaking backward compatibility.... */
2692 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
2693 howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2694 if (howto->partial_inplace && rel->r_addend)
2695 {
2696 r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
2697 rel->r_addend, contents,
2698 rel->r_offset, false,
2699 &error_message);
2700 rel->r_addend = 0;
2701 }
2702 else
2703 {
2704 /* Put the correct bits in the target instruction, even
2705 though the relocation will still be present in the output
2706 file. This makes disassembly clearer, as well as
2707 allowing loadable kernel modules to work without needing
2708 relocations on anything other than calls and l32r's. */
2709
2710 /* If it is not in the same section, there is nothing we can do. */
2711 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP &&
2712 sym_sec->output_section == input_section->output_section)
2713 {
2714 r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
2715 dest_addr, contents,
2716 rel->r_offset, false,
2717 &error_message);
2718 }
2719 }
2720 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2721 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2722 (info, error_message,
2723 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2724
2725 /* Done with work for relocatable link; continue with next reloc. */
2726 continue;
2727 }
2728
2729 /* This is a final link. */
2730
2731 if (relaxing_section)
2732 {
2733 /* Check if this references a section in another input file. */
2734 do_fix_for_final_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
2735 &relocation);
2736 }
2737
2738 /* Sanity check the address. */
2739 if (rel->r_offset >= input_size
2740 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
2741 {
2742 _bfd_error_handler
2743 /* xgettext:c-format */
2744 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): "
2745 "relocation offset out of range (size=%#" PRIx64 ")"),
2746 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
2747 (uint64_t) input_size);
2748 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2749 return false;
2750 }
2751
2752 if (h != NULL)
2753 name = h->root.root.string;
2754 else
2755 {
2756 name = (bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section
2757 (input_bfd, symtab_hdr->sh_link, sym->st_name));
2758 if (name == NULL || *name == '\0')
2759 name = bfd_section_name (sec);
2760 }
2761
2762 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
2763 && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
2764 && (h == NULL
2765 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2766 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2767 && IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
2768 {
2769 _bfd_error_handler
2770 ((sym_type == STT_TLS
2771 /* xgettext:c-format */
2772 ? _("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): %s used with TLS symbol %s")
2773 /* xgettext:c-format */
2774 : _("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): %s used with non-TLS symbol %s")),
2775 input_bfd,
2776 input_section,
2777 (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
2778 howto->name,
2779 name);
2780 }
2781
2782 dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
2783
2784 tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
2785 if (h)
2786 tls_type = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
2787 else if (local_got_tls_types)
2788 tls_type = local_got_tls_types [r_symndx];
2789
2790 switch (r_type)
2791 {
2792 case R_XTENSA_32:
2793 case R_XTENSA_PLT:
2794 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
2795 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2796 && (dynamic_symbol || bfd_link_pic (info)))
2797 {
2798 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2799 bfd_byte *loc;
2800 asection *srel;
2801
2802 if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
2803 srel = htab->elf.srelplt;
2804 else
2805 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
2806
2807 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
2808
2809 outrel.r_offset =
2810 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
2811 input_section, rel->r_offset);
2812
2813 if ((outrel.r_offset | 1) == (bfd_vma) -1)
2814 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
2815 else
2816 {
2817 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
2818 + input_section->output_offset);
2819
2820 /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2821 and not in a literal pool. */
2822 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2823 && !elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2824 outrel.r_offset))
2825 {
2826 error_message =
2827 _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2828 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2829 (info, error_message,
2830 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2831 }
2832
2833 if (dynamic_symbol)
2834 {
2835 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
2836 rel->r_addend = 0;
2837
2838 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_32)
2839 {
2840 outrel.r_info =
2841 ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT);
2842 relocation = 0;
2843 }
2844 else /* r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT */
2845 {
2846 outrel.r_info =
2847 ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT);
2848
2849 /* Create the PLT entry and set the initial
2850 contents of the literal entry to the address of
2851 the PLT entry. */
2852 relocation =
2853 elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (info, output_bfd,
2854 srel->reloc_count);
2855 }
2856 unresolved_reloc = false;
2857 }
2858 else if (!is_weak_undef)
2859 {
2860 /* Generate a RELATIVE relocation. */
2861 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RELATIVE);
2862 outrel.r_addend = 0;
2863 }
2864 else
2865 {
2866 continue;
2867 }
2868 }
2869
2870 loc = (srel->contents
2871 + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2872 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2873 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2874 <= srel->size);
2875 }
2876 else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND && dynamic_symbol)
2877 {
2878 /* This should only happen for non-PIC code, which is not
2879 supposed to be used on systems with dynamic linking.
2880 Just ignore these relocations. */
2881 continue;
2882 }
2883 break;
2884
2885 case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
2886 /* Switch to LE model for local symbols in an executable. */
2887 if (! bfd_link_pic (info) && ! dynamic_symbol)
2888 {
2889 relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2890 break;
2891 }
2892 /* fall through */
2893
2894 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
2895 case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
2896 {
2897 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN)
2898 {
2899 if (! bfd_link_pic (info) || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2900 r_type = R_XTENSA_NONE;
2901 }
2902 else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG)
2903 {
2904 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2905 {
2906 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2907 r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2908 }
2909 else
2910 {
2911 r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2912 if (! dynamic_symbol)
2913 {
2914 relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2915 break;
2916 }
2917 }
2918 }
2919
2920 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
2921 /* Nothing to do here; skip to the next reloc. */
2922 continue;
2923
2924 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2925 {
2926 error_message =
2927 _("TLS relocation invalid without dynamic sections");
2928 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2929 (info, error_message,
2930 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2931 }
2932 else
2933 {
2934 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2935 bfd_byte *loc;
2936 asection *srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
2937 int indx;
2938
2939 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
2940 + input_section->output_offset
2941 + rel->r_offset);
2942
2943 /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2944 and not in a literal pool. */
2945 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2946 && ! elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2947 outrel.r_offset))
2948 {
2949 error_message =
2950 _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2951 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2952 (info, error_message,
2953 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2954 }
2955
2956 indx = h && h->dynindx != -1 ? h->dynindx : 0;
2957 if (indx == 0)
2958 outrel.r_addend = relocation - dtpoff_base (info);
2959 else
2960 outrel.r_addend = 0;
2961 rel->r_addend = 0;
2962
2963 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
2964 relocation = 0;
2965 unresolved_reloc = false;
2966
2967 BFD_ASSERT (srel);
2968 loc = (srel->contents
2969 + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2970 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2971 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2972 <= srel->size);
2973 }
2974 }
2975 break;
2976
2977 case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
2978 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2979 /* Switch from LD model to LE model. */
2980 relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2981 else
2982 relocation -= dtpoff_base (info);
2983 break;
2984
2985 case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2986 case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2987 case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2988 /* Check if optimizing to IE or LE model. */
2989 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2990 {
2991 bool is_ld_model =
2992 (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) == htab->tlsbase);
2993 if (! replace_tls_insn (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
2994 is_ld_model, &error_message))
2995 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2996 (info, error_message,
2997 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
2998
2999 if (r_type != R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG || is_ld_model)
3000 {
3001 /* Skip subsequent relocations on the same instruction. */
3002 while (rel + 1 < relend && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset)
3003 rel++;
3004 }
3005 }
3006 continue;
3007
3008 default:
3009 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
3010 && dynamic_symbol && (is_operand_relocation (r_type)
3011 || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL))
3012 {
3013 error_message =
3014 vsprint_msg ("invalid relocation for dynamic symbol", ": %s",
3015 strlen (name) + 2, name);
3016 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3017 (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
3018 continue;
3019 }
3020 break;
3021 }
3022
3023 /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
3024 because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
3025 not process them. */
3026 if (unresolved_reloc
3027 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
3028 && h->def_dynamic)
3029 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
3030 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
3031 {
3032 _bfd_error_handler
3033 /* xgettext:c-format */
3034 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): "
3035 "unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'"),
3036 input_bfd,
3037 input_section,
3038 (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
3039 howto->name,
3040 name);
3041 return false;
3042 }
3043
3044 /* TLS optimizations may have changed r_type; update "howto". */
3045 howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
3046
3047 /* There's no point in calling bfd_perform_relocation here.
3048 Just go directly to our "special function". */
3049 r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
3050 relocation + rel->r_addend,
3051 contents, rel->r_offset, is_weak_undef,
3052 &error_message);
3053
3054 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok && !warned)
3055 {
3056 BFD_ASSERT (r == bfd_reloc_dangerous || r == bfd_reloc_other);
3057 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
3058
3059 if (rel->r_addend == 0)
3060 error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": %s",
3061 strlen (name) + 2, name);
3062 else
3063 error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": (%s+0x%x)",
3064 strlen (name) + 22,
3065 name, (int) rel->r_addend);
3066
3067 (*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3068 (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
3069 }
3070 }
3071
3072 free (lit_table);
3073 input_section->reloc_done = true;
3074
3075 return true;
3076 }
3077
3078
3079 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. There's not much to do here since
3080 the PLT and GOT entries are all set up by relocate_section. */
3081
3082 static bool
3083 elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3084 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3085 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3086 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
3087 {
3088 if (h->needs_plt && !h->def_regular)
3089 {
3090 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as defined in
3091 the .plt section. Leave the value alone. */
3092 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
3093 /* If the symbol is weak, we do need to clear the value.
3094 Otherwise, the PLT entry would provide a definition for
3095 the symbol even if the symbol wasn't defined anywhere,
3096 and so the symbol would never be NULL. */
3097 if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
3098 sym->st_value = 0;
3099 }
3100
3101 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
3102 if (h == elf_hash_table (info)->hdynamic
3103 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
3104 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
3105
3106 return true;
3107 }
3108
3109
3110 /* Combine adjacent literal table entries in the output. Adjacent
3111 entries within each input section may have been removed during
3112 relaxation, but we repeat the process here, even though it's too late
3113 to shrink the output section, because it's important to minimize the
3114 number of literal table entries to reduce the start-up work for the
3115 runtime linker. Returns the number of remaining table entries or -1
3116 on error. */
3117
3118 static int
3119 elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (bfd *output_bfd,
3120 asection *sxtlit,
3121 asection *sgotloc)
3122 {
3123 bfd_byte *contents;
3124 property_table_entry *table;
3125 bfd_size_type section_size, sgotloc_size;
3126 bfd_vma offset;
3127 int n, m, num;
3128
3129 section_size = sxtlit->size;
3130 if (section_size == 0)
3131 return 0;
3132
3133 BFD_ASSERT (section_size % 8 == 0);
3134 num = section_size / 8;
3135
3136 sgotloc_size = sgotloc->size;
3137 if (sgotloc_size != section_size)
3138 {
3139 _bfd_error_handler
3140 (_("internal inconsistency in size of .got.loc section"));
3141 return -1;
3142 }
3143
3144 table = bfd_malloc (num * sizeof (property_table_entry));
3145 if (table == 0)
3146 return -1;
3147
3148 /* The ".xt.lit.plt" section has the SEC_IN_MEMORY flag set and this
3149 propagates to the output section, where it doesn't really apply and
3150 where it breaks the following call to bfd_malloc_and_get_section. */
3151 sxtlit->flags &= ~SEC_IN_MEMORY;
3152
3153 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (output_bfd, sxtlit, &contents))
3154 {
3155 free (contents);
3156 free (table);
3157 return -1;
3158 }
3159
3160 /* There should never be any relocations left at this point, so this
3161 is quite a bit easier than what is done during relaxation. */
3162
3163 /* Copy the raw contents into a property table array and sort it. */
3164 offset = 0;
3165 for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3166 {
3167 table[n].address = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset]);
3168 table[n].size = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset + 4]);
3169 offset += 8;
3170 }
3171 qsort (table, num, sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_compare);
3172
3173 for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3174 {
3175 bool remove_entry = false;
3176
3177 if (table[n].size == 0)
3178 remove_entry = true;
3179 else if (n > 0
3180 && (table[n-1].address + table[n-1].size == table[n].address))
3181 {
3182 table[n-1].size += table[n].size;
3183 remove_entry = true;
3184 }
3185
3186 if (remove_entry)
3187 {
3188 for (m = n; m < num - 1; m++)
3189 {
3190 table[m].address = table[m+1].address;
3191 table[m].size = table[m+1].size;
3192 }
3193
3194 n--;
3195 num--;
3196 }
3197 }
3198
3199 /* Copy the data back to the raw contents. */
3200 offset = 0;
3201 for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3202 {
3203 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].address, &contents[offset]);
3204 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].size, &contents[offset + 4]);
3205 offset += 8;
3206 }
3207
3208 /* Clear the removed bytes. */
3209 if ((bfd_size_type) (num * 8) < section_size)
3210 memset (&contents[num * 8], 0, section_size - num * 8);
3211
3212 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sxtlit, contents, 0,
3213 section_size))
3214 return -1;
3215
3216 /* Copy the contents to ".got.loc". */
3217 memcpy (sgotloc->contents, contents, section_size);
3218
3219 free (contents);
3220 free (table);
3221 return num;
3222 }
3223
3224
3225 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
3226
3227 static bool
3228 elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
3229 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3230 {
3231 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
3232 bfd *dynobj;
3233 asection *sdyn, *srelplt, *srelgot, *sgot, *sxtlit, *sgotloc;
3234 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
3235 int num_xtlit_entries = 0;
3236
3237 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
3238 return true;
3239
3240 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
3241 if (htab == NULL)
3242 return false;
3243
3244 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3245 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
3246 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
3247
3248 /* Set the first entry in the global offset table to the address of
3249 the dynamic section. */
3250 sgot = htab->elf.sgot;
3251 if (sgot)
3252 {
3253 BFD_ASSERT (sgot->size == 4);
3254 if (sdyn == NULL)
3255 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
3256 else
3257 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3258 sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset,
3259 sgot->contents);
3260 }
3261
3262 srelplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
3263 srelgot = htab->elf.srelgot;
3264 if (srelplt && srelplt->size != 0)
3265 {
3266 asection *sgotplt, *spltlittbl;
3267 int chunk, plt_chunks, plt_entries;
3268 Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
3269 bfd_byte *loc;
3270 unsigned rtld_reloc;
3271
3272 spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
3273 BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL && spltlittbl != NULL);
3274
3275 /* Find the first XTENSA_RTLD relocation. Presumably the rest
3276 of them follow immediately after.... */
3277 for (rtld_reloc = 0; rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count; rtld_reloc++)
3278 {
3279 loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3280 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3281 if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD)
3282 break;
3283 }
3284 BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count);
3285
3286 plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3287 plt_chunks =
3288 (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3289
3290 for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
3291 {
3292 int chunk_entries = 0;
3293
3294 sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
3295 BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
3296
3297 /* Emit special RTLD relocations for the first two entries in
3298 each chunk of the .got.plt section. */
3299
3300 loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3301 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3302 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3303 irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3304 + sgotplt->output_offset);
3305 irela.r_addend = 1; /* tell rtld to set value to resolver function */
3306 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3307 rtld_reloc += 1;
3308 BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3309
3310 /* Next literal immediately follows the first. */
3311 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3312 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3313 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3314 irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3315 + sgotplt->output_offset + 4);
3316 /* Tell rtld to set value to object's link map. */
3317 irela.r_addend = 2;
3318 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3319 rtld_reloc += 1;
3320 BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3321
3322 /* Fill in the literal table. */
3323 if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
3324 chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3325 else
3326 chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
3327
3328 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned) (chunk + 1) * 8 <= spltlittbl->size);
3329 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3330 sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset,
3331 spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 0);
3332 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3333 8 + (chunk_entries * 4),
3334 spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 4);
3335 }
3336
3337 /* The .xt.lit.plt section has just been modified. This must
3338 happen before the code below which combines adjacent literal
3339 table entries, and the .xt.lit.plt contents have to be forced to
3340 the output here. */
3341 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd,
3342 spltlittbl->output_section,
3343 spltlittbl->contents,
3344 spltlittbl->output_offset,
3345 spltlittbl->size))
3346 return false;
3347 /* Clear SEC_HAS_CONTENTS so the contents won't be output again. */
3348 spltlittbl->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
3349 }
3350
3351 /* All the dynamic relocations have been emitted at this point.
3352 Make sure the relocation sections are the correct size. */
3353 if ((srelgot && srelgot->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3354 * srelgot->reloc_count))
3355 || (srelplt && srelplt->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3356 * srelplt->reloc_count)))
3357 abort ();
3358
3359 /* Combine adjacent literal table entries. */
3360 BFD_ASSERT (! bfd_link_relocatable (info));
3361 sxtlit = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".xt.lit");
3362 sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
3363 BFD_ASSERT (sgotloc);
3364 if (sxtlit)
3365 {
3366 num_xtlit_entries =
3367 elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (output_bfd, sxtlit, sgotloc);
3368 if (num_xtlit_entries < 0)
3369 return false;
3370 }
3371
3372 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
3373 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
3374 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
3375 {
3376 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
3377
3378 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
3379
3380 switch (dyn.d_tag)
3381 {
3382 default:
3383 break;
3384
3385 case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ:
3386 dyn.d_un.d_val = num_xtlit_entries;
3387 break;
3388
3389 case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF:
3390 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->sgotloc->output_section->vma
3391 + htab->sgotloc->output_offset);
3392 break;
3393
3394 case DT_PLTGOT:
3395 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
3396 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset);
3397 break;
3398
3399 case DT_JMPREL:
3400 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->elf.srelplt->output_section->vma
3401 + htab->elf.srelplt->output_offset);
3402 break;
3403
3404 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
3405 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
3406 break;
3407 }
3408
3409 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
3410 }
3411
3412 return true;
3413 }
3414
3415 \f
3416 /* Functions for dealing with the e_flags field. */
3417
3418 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3419 object file when linking. */
3420
3421 static bool
3422 elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3423 {
3424 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3425 unsigned out_mach, in_mach;
3426 flagword out_flag, in_flag;
3427
3428 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3429 if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3430 return false;
3431
3432 /* Don't even pretend to support mixed-format linking. */
3433 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
3434 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3435 return false;
3436
3437 out_flag = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3438 in_flag = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3439
3440 out_mach = out_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3441 in_mach = in_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3442 if (out_mach != in_mach)
3443 {
3444 _bfd_error_handler
3445 /* xgettext:c-format */
3446 (_("%pB: incompatible machine type; output is 0x%x; input is 0x%x"),
3447 ibfd, out_mach, in_mach);
3448 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
3449 return false;
3450 }
3451
3452 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
3453 {
3454 elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
3455 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = in_flag;
3456
3457 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
3458 && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
3459 return bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
3460 bfd_get_mach (ibfd));
3461
3462 return true;
3463 }
3464
3465 if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN))
3466 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN);
3467
3468 if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT))
3469 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT);
3470
3471 return true;
3472 }
3473
3474
3475 static bool
3476 elf_xtensa_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
3477 {
3478 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
3479 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
3480
3481 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= flags;
3482 elf_flags_init (abfd) = true;
3483
3484 return true;
3485 }
3486
3487
3488 static bool
3489 elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
3490 {
3491 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
3492 flagword e_flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
3493
3494 fprintf (f, "\nXtensa header:\n");
3495 if ((e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH) == E_XTENSA_MACH)
3496 fprintf (f, "\nMachine = Base\n");
3497 else
3498 fprintf (f, "\nMachine Id = 0x%x\n", e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH);
3499
3500 fprintf (f, "Insn tables = %s\n",
3501 (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) ? "true" : "false");
3502
3503 fprintf (f, "Literal tables = %s\n",
3504 (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) ? "true" : "false");
3505
3506 return _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, farg);
3507 }
3508
3509
3510 /* Set the right machine number for an Xtensa ELF file. */
3511
3512 static bool
3513 elf_xtensa_object_p (bfd *abfd)
3514 {
3515 int mach;
3516 unsigned long arch = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3517
3518 switch (arch)
3519 {
3520 case E_XTENSA_MACH:
3521 mach = bfd_mach_xtensa;
3522 break;
3523 default:
3524 return false;
3525 }
3526
3527 (void) bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_xtensa, mach);
3528 return true;
3529 }
3530
3531
3532 /* The final processing done just before writing out an Xtensa ELF object
3533 file. This gets the Xtensa architecture right based on the machine
3534 number. */
3535
3536 static bool
3537 elf_xtensa_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
3538 {
3539 int mach;
3540 unsigned long val = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3541
3542 switch (mach = bfd_get_mach (abfd))
3543 {
3544 case bfd_mach_xtensa:
3545 val = E_XTENSA_MACH;
3546 break;
3547 default:
3548 break;
3549 }
3550
3551 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3552 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
3553 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
3554 }
3555
3556
3557 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
3558 elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3559 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3560 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
3561 {
3562 switch ((int) ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
3563 {
3564 case R_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
3565 return reloc_class_relative;
3566 case R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
3567 return reloc_class_plt;
3568 default:
3569 return reloc_class_normal;
3570 }
3571 }
3572
3573 \f
3574 static bool
3575 elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (bfd *abfd,
3576 struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3577 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3578 asection *sec)
3579 {
3580 bfd_byte *contents;
3581 bfd_vma offset, actual_offset;
3582 bfd_size_type removed_bytes = 0;
3583 bfd_size_type entry_size;
3584
3585 if (sec->output_section
3586 && bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
3587 return false;
3588
3589 if (xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
3590 entry_size = 12;
3591 else
3592 entry_size = 8;
3593
3594 if (sec->size == 0 || sec->size % entry_size != 0)
3595 return false;
3596
3597 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3598 if (!contents)
3599 return false;
3600
3601 cookie->rels = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3602 if (!cookie->rels)
3603 {
3604 release_contents (sec, contents);
3605 return false;
3606 }
3607
3608 /* Sort the relocations. They should already be in order when
3609 relaxation is enabled, but it might not be. */
3610 qsort (cookie->rels, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
3611 internal_reloc_compare);
3612
3613 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
3614 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + sec->reloc_count;
3615
3616 for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
3617 {
3618 actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
3619
3620 /* The ...symbol_deleted_p function will skip over relocs but it
3621 won't adjust their offsets, so do that here. */
3622 while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3623 && cookie->rel->r_offset < offset)
3624 {
3625 cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3626 cookie->rel++;
3627 }
3628
3629 while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3630 && cookie->rel->r_offset == offset)
3631 {
3632 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (offset, cookie))
3633 {
3634 /* Remove the table entry. (If the reloc type is NONE, then
3635 the entry has already been merged with another and deleted
3636 during relaxation.) */
3637 if (ELF32_R_TYPE (cookie->rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
3638 {
3639 /* Shift the contents up. */
3640 if (offset + entry_size < sec->size)
3641 memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
3642 &contents[actual_offset + entry_size],
3643 sec->size - offset - entry_size);
3644 removed_bytes += entry_size;
3645 }
3646
3647 /* Remove this relocation. */
3648 cookie->rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
3649 }
3650
3651 /* Adjust the relocation offset for previous removals. This
3652 should not be done before calling ...symbol_deleted_p
3653 because it might mess up the offset comparisons there.
3654 Make sure the offset doesn't underflow in the case where
3655 the first entry is removed. */
3656 if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3657 cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3658 else
3659 cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3660
3661 cookie->rel++;
3662 }
3663 }
3664
3665 if (removed_bytes != 0)
3666 {
3667 /* Adjust any remaining relocs (shouldn't be any). */
3668 for (; cookie->rel < cookie->relend; cookie->rel++)
3669 {
3670 if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3671 cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3672 else
3673 cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3674 }
3675
3676 /* Clear the removed bytes. */
3677 memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
3678
3679 pin_contents (sec, contents);
3680 pin_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3681
3682 /* Shrink size. */
3683 if (sec->rawsize == 0)
3684 sec->rawsize = sec->size;
3685 sec->size -= removed_bytes;
3686
3687 if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
3688 {
3689 asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info)->sgotloc;
3690 if (sgotloc)
3691 sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
3692 }
3693 }
3694 else
3695 {
3696 release_contents (sec, contents);
3697 release_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3698 }
3699
3700 return (removed_bytes != 0);
3701 }
3702
3703
3704 static bool
3705 elf_xtensa_discard_info (bfd *abfd,
3706 struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3707 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3708 {
3709 asection *sec;
3710 bool changed = false;
3711
3712 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3713 {
3714 if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
3715 {
3716 if (elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (abfd, cookie, info, sec))
3717 changed = true;
3718 }
3719 }
3720
3721 return changed;
3722 }
3723
3724
3725 static bool
3726 elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
3727 {
3728 return xtensa_is_property_section (sec);
3729 }
3730
3731
3732 static unsigned int
3733 elf_xtensa_action_discarded (asection *sec)
3734 {
3735 if (strcmp (".xt_except_table", sec->name) == 0)
3736 return 0;
3737
3738 if (strcmp (".xt_except_desc", sec->name) == 0)
3739 return 0;
3740
3741 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
3742 }
3743
3744 \f
3745 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
3746
3747 static bool
3748 elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3749 {
3750 int offset;
3751 unsigned int size;
3752
3753 if (elf_tdata (abfd) == NULL
3754 || elf_tdata (abfd)->core == NULL)
3755 return false;
3756
3757 /* The size for Xtensa is variable, so don't try to recognize the format
3758 based on the size. Just assume this is GNU/Linux. */
3759 if (note == NULL || note->descsz < 28)
3760 return false;
3761
3762 /* pr_cursig */
3763 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
3764
3765 /* pr_pid */
3766 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
3767
3768 /* pr_reg */
3769 offset = 72;
3770 size = note->descsz - offset - 4;
3771
3772 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
3773 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
3774 size, note->descpos + offset);
3775 }
3776
3777 static bool
3778 elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3779 {
3780 switch (note->descsz)
3781 {
3782 default:
3783 return false;
3784
3785 case 128: /* GNU/Linux elf_prpsinfo */
3786 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
3787 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
3788 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
3789 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
3790 }
3791
3792 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
3793 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
3794 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
3795
3796 {
3797 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
3798 int n = strlen (command);
3799
3800 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
3801 command[n - 1] = '\0';
3802 }
3803
3804 return true;
3805 }
3806
3807 \f
3808 /* Generic Xtensa configurability stuff. */
3809
3810 static xtensa_opcode callx0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3811 static xtensa_opcode callx4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3812 static xtensa_opcode callx8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3813 static xtensa_opcode callx12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3814 static xtensa_opcode call0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3815 static xtensa_opcode call4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3816 static xtensa_opcode call8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3817 static xtensa_opcode call12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3818
3819 static void
3820 init_call_opcodes (void)
3821 {
3822 if (callx0_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3823 {
3824 callx0_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx0");
3825 callx4_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx4");
3826 callx8_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx8");
3827 callx12_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx12");
3828 call0_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call0");
3829 call4_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call4");
3830 call8_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call8");
3831 call12_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call12");
3832 }
3833 }
3834
3835
3836 static bool
3837 is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3838 {
3839 init_call_opcodes ();
3840 return (opcode == callx0_op
3841 || opcode == callx4_op
3842 || opcode == callx8_op
3843 || opcode == callx12_op);
3844 }
3845
3846
3847 static bool
3848 is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3849 {
3850 init_call_opcodes ();
3851 return (opcode == call0_op
3852 || opcode == call4_op
3853 || opcode == call8_op
3854 || opcode == call12_op);
3855 }
3856
3857
3858 static bool
3859 is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3860 {
3861 init_call_opcodes ();
3862 return (opcode == call4_op
3863 || opcode == call8_op
3864 || opcode == call12_op
3865 || opcode == callx4_op
3866 || opcode == callx8_op
3867 || opcode == callx12_op);
3868 }
3869
3870
3871 static bool
3872 get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode opcode, unsigned *pdst)
3873 {
3874 unsigned dst = (unsigned) -1;
3875
3876 init_call_opcodes ();
3877 if (opcode == callx0_op)
3878 dst = 0;
3879 else if (opcode == callx4_op)
3880 dst = 4;
3881 else if (opcode == callx8_op)
3882 dst = 8;
3883 else if (opcode == callx12_op)
3884 dst = 12;
3885
3886 if (dst == (unsigned) -1)
3887 return false;
3888
3889 *pdst = dst;
3890 return true;
3891 }
3892
3893
3894 static xtensa_opcode
3895 get_const16_opcode (void)
3896 {
3897 static bool done_lookup = false;
3898 static xtensa_opcode const16_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3899 if (!done_lookup)
3900 {
3901 const16_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "const16");
3902 done_lookup = true;
3903 }
3904 return const16_opcode;
3905 }
3906
3907
3908 static xtensa_opcode
3909 get_l32r_opcode (void)
3910 {
3911 static xtensa_opcode l32r_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3912 static bool done_lookup = false;
3913
3914 if (!done_lookup)
3915 {
3916 l32r_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "l32r");
3917 done_lookup = true;
3918 }
3919 return l32r_opcode;
3920 }
3921
3922
3923 static bfd_vma
3924 l32r_offset (bfd_vma addr, bfd_vma pc)
3925 {
3926 bfd_vma offset;
3927
3928 offset = addr - ((pc+3) & -4);
3929 BFD_ASSERT ((offset & ((1 << 2) - 1)) == 0);
3930 offset = (signed int) offset >> 2;
3931 BFD_ASSERT ((signed int) offset >> 16 == -1);
3932 return offset;
3933 }
3934
3935
3936 static xtensa_opcode
3937 get_rsr_lend_opcode (void)
3938 {
3939 static xtensa_opcode rsr_lend_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3940 static bool done_lookup = false;
3941 if (!done_lookup)
3942 {
3943 rsr_lend_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "rsr.lend");
3944 done_lookup = true;
3945 }
3946 return rsr_lend_opcode;
3947 }
3948
3949 static xtensa_opcode
3950 get_wsr_lbeg_opcode (void)
3951 {
3952 static xtensa_opcode wsr_lbeg_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3953 static bool done_lookup = false;
3954 if (!done_lookup)
3955 {
3956 wsr_lbeg_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "wsr.lbeg");
3957 done_lookup = true;
3958 }
3959 return wsr_lbeg_opcode;
3960 }
3961
3962
3963 static int
3964 get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode opcode, int r_type)
3965 {
3966 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
3967 int last_immed, last_opnd, opi;
3968
3969 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3970 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3971
3972 /* Find the last visible PC-relative immediate operand for the opcode.
3973 If there are no PC-relative immediates, then choose the last visible
3974 immediate; otherwise, fail and return XTENSA_UNDEFINED. */
3975 last_immed = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3976 last_opnd = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
3977 for (opi = last_opnd - 1; opi >= 0; opi--)
3978 {
3979 if (xtensa_operand_is_visible (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3980 continue;
3981 if (xtensa_operand_is_PCrelative (isa, opcode, opi) == 1)
3982 {
3983 last_immed = opi;
3984 break;
3985 }
3986 if (last_immed == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
3987 && xtensa_operand_is_register (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3988 last_immed = opi;
3989 }
3990 if (last_immed < 0)
3991 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3992
3993 /* If the operand number was specified in an old-style relocation,
3994 check for consistency with the operand computed above. */
3995 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_OP0 && r_type <= R_XTENSA_OP2)
3996 {
3997 int reloc_opnd = r_type - R_XTENSA_OP0;
3998 if (reloc_opnd != last_immed)
3999 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4000 }
4001
4002 return last_immed;
4003 }
4004
4005
4006 int
4007 get_relocation_slot (int r_type)
4008 {
4009 switch (r_type)
4010 {
4011 case R_XTENSA_OP0:
4012 case R_XTENSA_OP1:
4013 case R_XTENSA_OP2:
4014 return 0;
4015
4016 default:
4017 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
4018 return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP;
4019 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
4020 return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT;
4021 break;
4022 }
4023
4024 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4025 }
4026
4027
4028 /* Get the opcode for a relocation. */
4029
4030 static xtensa_opcode
4031 get_relocation_opcode (bfd *abfd,
4032 asection *sec,
4033 bfd_byte *contents,
4034 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
4035 {
4036 static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4037 static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
4038 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4039 xtensa_format fmt;
4040 int slot;
4041
4042 if (contents == NULL)
4043 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4044
4045 if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) <= irel->r_offset)
4046 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4047
4048 if (ibuff == NULL)
4049 {
4050 ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4051 sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4052 }
4053
4054 /* Decode the instruction. */
4055 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[irel->r_offset],
4056 sec->size - irel->r_offset);
4057 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4058 slot = get_relocation_slot (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
4059 if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4060 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4061 xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
4062 return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
4063 }
4064
4065
4066 bool
4067 is_l32r_relocation (bfd *abfd,
4068 asection *sec,
4069 bfd_byte *contents,
4070 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
4071 {
4072 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4073 if (!is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
4074 return false;
4075 opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
4076 return (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
4077 }
4078
4079
4080 static bfd_size_type
4081 get_asm_simplify_size (bfd_byte *contents,
4082 bfd_size_type content_len,
4083 bfd_size_type offset)
4084 {
4085 bfd_size_type insnlen, size = 0;
4086
4087 /* Decode the size of the next two instructions. */
4088 insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
4089 if (insnlen == 0)
4090 return 0;
4091
4092 size += insnlen;
4093
4094 insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset + size);
4095 if (insnlen == 0)
4096 return 0;
4097
4098 size += insnlen;
4099 return size;
4100 }
4101
4102
4103 bool
4104 is_alt_relocation (int r_type)
4105 {
4106 return (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
4107 && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT);
4108 }
4109
4110
4111 bool
4112 is_operand_relocation (int r_type)
4113 {
4114 switch (r_type)
4115 {
4116 case R_XTENSA_OP0:
4117 case R_XTENSA_OP1:
4118 case R_XTENSA_OP2:
4119 return true;
4120
4121 default:
4122 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
4123 return true;
4124 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
4125 return true;
4126 break;
4127 }
4128
4129 return false;
4130 }
4131
4132
4133 #define MIN_INSN_LENGTH 2
4134
4135 /* Return 0 if it fails to decode. */
4136
4137 bfd_size_type
4138 insn_decode_len (bfd_byte *contents,
4139 bfd_size_type content_len,
4140 bfd_size_type offset)
4141 {
4142 int insn_len;
4143 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4144 xtensa_format fmt;
4145 static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4146
4147 if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4148 return 0;
4149
4150 if (ibuff == NULL)
4151 ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4152 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[offset],
4153 content_len - offset);
4154 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4155 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4156 return 0;
4157 insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4158 if (insn_len == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4159 return 0;
4160 return insn_len;
4161 }
4162
4163 int
4164 insn_num_slots (bfd_byte *contents,
4165 bfd_size_type content_len,
4166 bfd_size_type offset)
4167 {
4168 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4169 xtensa_format fmt;
4170 static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4171
4172 if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4173 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4174
4175 if (ibuff == NULL)
4176 ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4177 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[offset],
4178 content_len - offset);
4179 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4180 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4181 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4182 return xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt);
4183 }
4184
4185
4186 /* Decode the opcode for a single slot instruction.
4187 Return 0 if it fails to decode or the instruction is multi-slot. */
4188
4189 xtensa_opcode
4190 insn_decode_opcode (bfd_byte *contents,
4191 bfd_size_type content_len,
4192 bfd_size_type offset,
4193 int slot)
4194 {
4195 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4196 xtensa_format fmt;
4197 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4198 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4199
4200 if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4201 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4202
4203 if (insnbuf == NULL)
4204 {
4205 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4206 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4207 }
4208
4209 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4210 content_len - offset);
4211 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4212 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4213 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4214
4215 if (slot >= xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt))
4216 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4217
4218 xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4219 return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, slotbuf);
4220 }
4221
4222
4223 /* The offset is the offset in the contents.
4224 The address is the address of that offset. */
4225
4226 static bool
4227 check_branch_target_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4228 bfd_size_type content_length,
4229 bfd_vma offset,
4230 bfd_vma address)
4231 {
4232 bfd_size_type insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4233 if (insn_len == 0)
4234 return false;
4235 return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address, insn_len);
4236 }
4237
4238
4239 static bool
4240 check_loop_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4241 bfd_size_type content_length,
4242 bfd_vma offset,
4243 bfd_vma address)
4244 {
4245 bfd_size_type loop_len, insn_len;
4246 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4247
4248 opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset, 0);
4249 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4250 || xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) != 1)
4251 {
4252 BFD_ASSERT (false);
4253 return false;
4254 }
4255
4256 loop_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4257 insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len);
4258 if (loop_len == 0 || insn_len == 0)
4259 {
4260 BFD_ASSERT (false);
4261 return false;
4262 }
4263
4264 /* If this is relaxed loop, analyze first instruction of the actual loop
4265 body. It must be at offset 27 from the loop instruction address. */
4266 if (insn_len == 3
4267 && insn_num_slots (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len) == 1
4268 && insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length,
4269 offset + loop_len, 0) == get_rsr_lend_opcode()
4270 && insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len + 3) == 3
4271 && insn_num_slots (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len + 3) == 1
4272 && insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length,
4273 offset + loop_len + 3, 0) == get_wsr_lbeg_opcode())
4274 {
4275 loop_len = 27;
4276 insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len);
4277 }
4278 return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address + loop_len, insn_len);
4279 }
4280
4281
4282 static bool
4283 check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma addr, int len)
4284 {
4285 if (len == 8)
4286 return (addr % 8 == 0);
4287 return ((addr >> 2) == ((addr + len - 1) >> 2));
4288 }
4289
4290 \f
4291 /* Instruction widening and narrowing. */
4292
4293 /* When FLIX is available we need to access certain instructions only
4294 when they are 16-bit or 24-bit instructions. This table caches
4295 information about such instructions by walking through all the
4296 opcodes and finding the smallest single-slot format into which each
4297 can be encoded. */
4298
4299 static xtensa_format *op_single_fmt_table = NULL;
4300
4301
4302 static void
4303 init_op_single_format_table (void)
4304 {
4305 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4306 xtensa_insnbuf ibuf;
4307 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4308 xtensa_format fmt;
4309 int num_opcodes;
4310
4311 if (op_single_fmt_table)
4312 return;
4313
4314 ibuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4315 num_opcodes = xtensa_isa_num_opcodes (isa);
4316
4317 op_single_fmt_table = (xtensa_format *)
4318 bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_format) * num_opcodes);
4319 for (opcode = 0; opcode < num_opcodes; opcode++)
4320 {
4321 op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4322 for (fmt = 0; fmt < xtensa_isa_num_formats (isa); fmt++)
4323 {
4324 if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1
4325 && xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, ibuf, opcode) == 0)
4326 {
4327 xtensa_opcode old_fmt = op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4328 int fmt_length = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4329 if (old_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4330 || fmt_length < xtensa_format_length (isa, old_fmt))
4331 op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = fmt;
4332 }
4333 }
4334 }
4335 xtensa_insnbuf_free (isa, ibuf);
4336 }
4337
4338
4339 static xtensa_format
4340 get_single_format (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4341 {
4342 init_op_single_format_table ();
4343 return op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4344 }
4345
4346
4347 /* For the set of narrowable instructions we do NOT include the
4348 narrowings beqz -> beqz.n or bnez -> bnez.n because of complexities
4349 involved during linker relaxation that may require these to
4350 re-expand in some conditions. Also, the narrowing "or" -> mov.n
4351 requires special case code to ensure it only works when op1 == op2. */
4352
4353 struct string_pair
4354 {
4355 const char *wide;
4356 const char *narrow;
4357 };
4358
4359 const struct string_pair narrowable[] =
4360 {
4361 { "add", "add.n" },
4362 { "addi", "addi.n" },
4363 { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4364 { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4365 { "movi", "movi.n" },
4366 { "ret", "ret.n" },
4367 { "retw", "retw.n" },
4368 { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4369 { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4370 };
4371
4372 const struct string_pair widenable[] =
4373 {
4374 { "add", "add.n" },
4375 { "addi", "addi.n" },
4376 { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4377 { "beqz", "beqz.n" },
4378 { "bnez", "bnez.n" },
4379 { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4380 { "movi", "movi.n" },
4381 { "ret", "ret.n" },
4382 { "retw", "retw.n" },
4383 { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4384 { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4385 };
4386
4387
4388 /* Check if an instruction can be "narrowed", i.e., changed from a standard
4389 3-byte instruction to a 2-byte "density" instruction. If it is valid,
4390 return the instruction buffer holding the narrow instruction. Otherwise,
4391 return 0. The set of valid narrowing are specified by a string table
4392 but require some special case operand checks in some cases. */
4393
4394 static xtensa_insnbuf
4395 can_narrow_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4396 xtensa_format fmt,
4397 xtensa_opcode opcode)
4398 {
4399 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4400 xtensa_format o_fmt;
4401 unsigned opi;
4402
4403 static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4404 static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4405
4406 if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4407 {
4408 o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4409 o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4410 }
4411
4412 for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (narrowable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4413 {
4414 bool is_or = (strcmp ("or", narrowable[opi].wide) == 0);
4415
4416 if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].wide))
4417 {
4418 uint32 value, newval;
4419 int i, operand_count, o_operand_count;
4420 xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4421
4422 /* Address does not matter in this case. We might need to
4423 fix it to handle branches/jumps. */
4424 bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4425
4426 o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].narrow);
4427 if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4428 return 0;
4429 o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4430 if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4431 return 0;
4432
4433 if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 3
4434 || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 2)
4435 return 0;
4436
4437 xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4438 operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4439 o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4440
4441 if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4442 return 0;
4443
4444 if (!is_or)
4445 {
4446 if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4447 return 0;
4448 }
4449 else
4450 {
4451 uint32 rawval0, rawval1, rawval2;
4452
4453 if (o_operand_count + 1 != operand_count
4454 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4455 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4456 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4457 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4458 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 2,
4459 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval2) != 0
4460 || rawval1 != rawval2
4461 || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4462 return 0;
4463 }
4464
4465 for (i = 0; i < o_operand_count; ++i)
4466 {
4467 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, i, fmt, 0,
4468 slotbuf, &value)
4469 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, i, &value))
4470 return 0;
4471
4472 /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4473 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation. */
4474 newval = value;
4475 if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4476 self_address)
4477 || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4478 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4479 o_slotbuf, newval))
4480 return 0;
4481 }
4482
4483 if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4484 return 0;
4485
4486 return o_insnbuf;
4487 }
4488 }
4489 return 0;
4490 }
4491
4492
4493 /* Attempt to narrow an instruction. If the narrowing is valid, perform
4494 the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE. Otherwise,
4495 the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified. */
4496
4497 static bool
4498 narrow_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4499 bfd_size_type content_length,
4500 bfd_size_type offset)
4501 {
4502 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4503 bfd_size_type insn_len;
4504 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4505 xtensa_format fmt;
4506 xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4507
4508 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4509 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4510
4511 if (insnbuf == NULL)
4512 {
4513 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4514 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4515 }
4516
4517 BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4518
4519 if (content_length < 2)
4520 return false;
4521
4522 /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4523 These have all been specified in the assembler aleady. */
4524 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4525 content_length - offset);
4526 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4527 if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4528 return false;
4529
4530 if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4531 return false;
4532
4533 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4534 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4535 return false;
4536 insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4537 if (insn_len > content_length)
4538 return false;
4539
4540 o_insnbuf = can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4541 if (o_insnbuf)
4542 {
4543 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4544 content_length - offset);
4545 return true;
4546 }
4547
4548 return false;
4549 }
4550
4551
4552 /* Check if an instruction can be "widened", i.e., changed from a 2-byte
4553 "density" instruction to a standard 3-byte instruction. If it is valid,
4554 return the instruction buffer holding the wide instruction. Otherwise,
4555 return 0. The set of valid widenings are specified by a string table
4556 but require some special case operand checks in some cases. */
4557
4558 static xtensa_insnbuf
4559 can_widen_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4560 xtensa_format fmt,
4561 xtensa_opcode opcode)
4562 {
4563 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4564 xtensa_format o_fmt;
4565 unsigned opi;
4566
4567 static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4568 static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4569
4570 if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4571 {
4572 o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4573 o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4574 }
4575
4576 for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (widenable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4577 {
4578 bool is_or = (strcmp ("or", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4579 bool is_branch = (strcmp ("beqz", widenable[opi].wide) == 0
4580 || strcmp ("bnez", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4581
4582 if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].narrow))
4583 {
4584 uint32 value, newval;
4585 int i, operand_count, o_operand_count, check_operand_count;
4586 xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4587
4588 /* Address does not matter in this case. We might need to fix it
4589 to handle branches/jumps. */
4590 bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4591
4592 o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].wide);
4593 if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4594 return 0;
4595 o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4596 if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4597 return 0;
4598
4599 if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 2
4600 || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 3)
4601 return 0;
4602
4603 xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4604 operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4605 o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4606 check_operand_count = o_operand_count;
4607
4608 if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4609 return 0;
4610
4611 if (!is_or)
4612 {
4613 if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4614 return 0;
4615 }
4616 else
4617 {
4618 uint32 rawval0, rawval1;
4619
4620 if (o_operand_count != operand_count + 1
4621 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4622 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4623 || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4624 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4625 || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4626 return 0;
4627 }
4628 if (is_branch)
4629 check_operand_count--;
4630
4631 for (i = 0; i < check_operand_count; i++)
4632 {
4633 int new_i = i;
4634 if (is_or && i == o_operand_count - 1)
4635 new_i = i - 1;
4636 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, new_i, fmt, 0,
4637 slotbuf, &value)
4638 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, new_i, &value))
4639 return 0;
4640
4641 /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4642 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation. */
4643 newval = value;
4644 if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4645 self_address)
4646 || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4647 || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4648 o_slotbuf, newval))
4649 return 0;
4650 }
4651
4652 if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4653 return 0;
4654
4655 return o_insnbuf;
4656 }
4657 }
4658 return 0;
4659 }
4660
4661
4662 /* Attempt to widen an instruction. If the widening is valid, perform
4663 the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE. Otherwise,
4664 the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified. */
4665
4666 static bool
4667 widen_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4668 bfd_size_type content_length,
4669 bfd_size_type offset)
4670 {
4671 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4672 bfd_size_type insn_len;
4673 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4674 xtensa_format fmt;
4675 xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4676
4677 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4678 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4679
4680 if (insnbuf == NULL)
4681 {
4682 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4683 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4684 }
4685
4686 BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4687
4688 if (content_length < 2)
4689 return false;
4690
4691 /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4692 These have all been specified in the assembler aleady. */
4693 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4694 content_length - offset);
4695 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4696 if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4697 return false;
4698
4699 if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4700 return false;
4701
4702 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4703 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4704 return false;
4705 insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4706 if (insn_len > content_length)
4707 return false;
4708
4709 o_insnbuf = can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4710 if (o_insnbuf)
4711 {
4712 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4713 content_length - offset);
4714 return true;
4715 }
4716 return false;
4717 }
4718
4719 \f
4720 /* Code for transforming CALLs at link-time. */
4721
4722 static bfd_reloc_status_type
4723 elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (bfd_byte *contents,
4724 bfd_vma address,
4725 bfd_vma content_length,
4726 char **error_message)
4727 {
4728 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4729 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4730 xtensa_format core_format = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4731 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4732 xtensa_opcode direct_call_opcode;
4733 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4734 bfd_byte *chbuf = contents + address;
4735 int opn;
4736
4737 if (insnbuf == NULL)
4738 {
4739 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4740 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4741 }
4742
4743 if (content_length < address)
4744 {
4745 *error_message = _("attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4746 return bfd_reloc_other;
4747 }
4748
4749 opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (chbuf, content_length - address, 0);
4750 direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
4751 if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4752 {
4753 *error_message = _("attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4754 return bfd_reloc_other;
4755 }
4756
4757 /* Assemble a NOP ("or a1, a1, a1") into the 0 byte offset. */
4758 core_format = xtensa_format_lookup (isa, "x24");
4759 opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
4760 xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, opcode);
4761 for (opn = 0; opn < 3; opn++)
4762 {
4763 uint32 regno = 1;
4764 xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opn, &regno);
4765 xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opn, core_format, 0,
4766 slotbuf, regno);
4767 }
4768 xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4769 xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4770 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf, content_length - address);
4771
4772 /* Assemble a CALL ("callN 0") into the 3 byte offset. */
4773 xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, direct_call_opcode);
4774 xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, 0, core_format, 0, slotbuf, 0);
4775
4776 xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4777 xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4778 xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf + 3,
4779 content_length - address - 3);
4780
4781 return bfd_reloc_ok;
4782 }
4783
4784
4785 static bfd_reloc_status_type
4786 contract_asm_expansion (bfd_byte *contents,
4787 bfd_vma content_length,
4788 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
4789 char **error_message)
4790 {
4791 bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
4792 elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, irel->r_offset, content_length,
4793 error_message);
4794
4795 if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
4796 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
4797
4798 /* Update the irel->r_offset field so that the right immediate and
4799 the right instruction are modified during the relocation. */
4800 irel->r_offset += 3;
4801 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP);
4802 return bfd_reloc_ok;
4803 }
4804
4805
4806 static xtensa_opcode
4807 swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4808 {
4809 init_call_opcodes ();
4810
4811 if (opcode == callx0_op) return call0_op;
4812 if (opcode == callx4_op) return call4_op;
4813 if (opcode == callx8_op) return call8_op;
4814 if (opcode == callx12_op) return call12_op;
4815
4816 /* Return XTENSA_UNDEFINED if the opcode is not an indirect call. */
4817 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4818 }
4819
4820
4821 /* Check if "buf" is pointing to a "L32R aN; CALLX aN" or "CONST16 aN;
4822 CONST16 aN; CALLX aN" sequence, and if so, return the CALLX opcode.
4823 If not, return XTENSA_UNDEFINED. */
4824
4825 #define L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4826 #define CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4827 #define CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND 0
4828
4829 static xtensa_opcode
4830 get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *buf, int bufsize, bool *p_uses_l32r)
4831 {
4832 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4833 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4834 xtensa_format fmt;
4835 xtensa_opcode opcode;
4836 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4837 uint32 regno, const16_regno, call_regno;
4838 int offset = 0;
4839
4840 if (insnbuf == NULL)
4841 {
4842 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4843 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4844 }
4845
4846 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf, bufsize);
4847 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4848 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4849 || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4850 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4851
4852 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4853 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4854 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4855
4856 if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
4857 {
4858 if (p_uses_l32r)
4859 *p_uses_l32r = true;
4860 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4861 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4862 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4863 &regno))
4864 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4865 }
4866 else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
4867 {
4868 if (p_uses_l32r)
4869 *p_uses_l32r = false;
4870 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4871 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4872 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4873 &regno))
4874 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4875
4876 /* Check that the next instruction is also CONST16. */
4877 offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4878 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4879 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4880 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4881 || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4882 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4883 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4884 if (opcode != get_const16_opcode ())
4885 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4886
4887 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4888 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &const16_regno)
4889 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4890 &const16_regno)
4891 || const16_regno != regno)
4892 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4893 }
4894 else
4895 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4896
4897 /* Next instruction should be an CALLXn with operand 0 == regno. */
4898 offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4899 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4900 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4901 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4902 || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4903 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4904 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4905 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4906 || !is_indirect_call_opcode (opcode))
4907 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4908
4909 if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4910 fmt, 0, slotbuf, &call_regno)
4911 || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4912 &call_regno))
4913 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4914
4915 if (call_regno != regno)
4916 return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4917
4918 return opcode;
4919 }
4920
4921 \f
4922 /* Data structures used during relaxation. */
4923
4924 /* r_reloc: relocation values. */
4925
4926 /* Through the relaxation process, we need to keep track of the values
4927 that will result from evaluating relocations. The standard ELF
4928 relocation structure is not sufficient for this purpose because we're
4929 operating on multiple input files at once, so we need to know which
4930 input file a relocation refers to. The r_reloc structure thus
4931 records both the input file (bfd) and ELF relocation.
4932
4933 For efficiency, an r_reloc also contains a "target_offset" field to
4934 cache the target-section-relative offset value that is represented by
4935 the relocation.
4936
4937 The r_reloc also contains a virtual offset that allows multiple
4938 inserted literals to be placed at the same "address" with
4939 different offsets. */
4940
4941 typedef struct r_reloc_struct r_reloc;
4942
4943 struct r_reloc_struct
4944 {
4945 bfd *abfd;
4946 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
4947 bfd_vma target_offset;
4948 bfd_vma virtual_offset;
4949 };
4950
4951
4952 /* The r_reloc structure is included by value in literal_value, but not
4953 every literal_value has an associated relocation -- some are simple
4954 constants. In such cases, we set all the fields in the r_reloc
4955 struct to zero. The r_reloc_is_const function should be used to
4956 detect this case. */
4957
4958 static bool
4959 r_reloc_is_const (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4960 {
4961 return (r_rel->abfd == NULL);
4962 }
4963
4964
4965 static bfd_vma
4966 r_reloc_get_target_offset (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4967 {
4968 bfd_vma target_offset;
4969 unsigned long r_symndx;
4970
4971 BFD_ASSERT (!r_reloc_is_const (r_rel));
4972 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4973 target_offset = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4974 return (target_offset + r_rel->rela.r_addend);
4975 }
4976
4977
4978 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4979 r_reloc_get_hash_entry (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4980 {
4981 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4982 return get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4983 }
4984
4985
4986 static asection *
4987 r_reloc_get_section (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4988 {
4989 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4990 return get_elf_r_symndx_section (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4991 }
4992
4993
4994 static bool
4995 r_reloc_is_defined (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4996 {
4997 asection *sec;
4998 if (r_rel == NULL)
4999 return false;
5000
5001 sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
5002 if (sec == bfd_abs_section_ptr
5003 || sec == bfd_com_section_ptr
5004 || sec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
5005 return false;
5006 return true;
5007 }
5008
5009
5010 static void
5011 r_reloc_init (r_reloc *r_rel,
5012 bfd *abfd,
5013 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
5014 bfd_byte *contents,
5015 bfd_size_type content_length)
5016 {
5017 int r_type;
5018 reloc_howto_type *howto;
5019
5020 if (irel)
5021 {
5022 r_rel->rela = *irel;
5023 r_rel->abfd = abfd;
5024 r_rel->target_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
5025 r_rel->virtual_offset = 0;
5026 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
5027 howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
5028 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5029 {
5030 bfd_vma inplace_val;
5031 BFD_ASSERT (r_rel->rela.r_offset < content_length);
5032
5033 inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[r_rel->rela.r_offset]);
5034 r_rel->target_offset += inplace_val;
5035 }
5036 }
5037 else
5038 memset (r_rel, 0, sizeof (r_reloc));
5039 }
5040
5041
5042 #if DEBUG
5043
5044 static void
5045 print_r_reloc (FILE *fp, const r_reloc *r_rel)
5046 {
5047 if (r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
5048 {
5049 asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
5050 fprintf (fp, " %s(%s + ", sec->owner->filename, sec->name);
5051 }
5052 else if (r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel))
5053 fprintf (fp, " %s + ", r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel)->root.root.string);
5054 else
5055 fprintf (fp, " ?? + ");
5056
5057 fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->target_offset);
5058 if (r_rel->virtual_offset)
5059 {
5060 fprintf (fp, " + ");
5061 fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->virtual_offset);
5062 }
5063
5064 fprintf (fp, ")");
5065 }
5066
5067 #endif /* DEBUG */
5068
5069 \f
5070 /* source_reloc: relocations that reference literals. */
5071
5072 /* To determine whether literals can be coalesced, we need to first
5073 record all the relocations that reference the literals. The
5074 source_reloc structure below is used for this purpose. The
5075 source_reloc entries are kept in a per-literal-section array, sorted
5076 by offset within the literal section (i.e., target offset).
5077
5078 The source_sec and r_rel.rela.r_offset fields identify the source of
5079 the relocation. The r_rel field records the relocation value, i.e.,
5080 the offset of the literal being referenced. The opnd field is needed
5081 to determine the range of the immediate field to which the relocation
5082 applies, so we can determine whether another literal with the same
5083 value is within range. The is_null field is true when the relocation
5084 is being removed (e.g., when an L32R is being removed due to a CALLX
5085 that is converted to a direct CALL). */
5086
5087 typedef struct source_reloc_struct source_reloc;
5088
5089 struct source_reloc_struct
5090 {
5091 asection *source_sec;
5092 r_reloc r_rel;
5093 xtensa_opcode opcode;
5094 int opnd;
5095 bool is_null;
5096 bool is_abs_literal;
5097 };
5098
5099
5100 static void
5101 init_source_reloc (source_reloc *reloc,
5102 asection *source_sec,
5103 const r_reloc *r_rel,
5104 xtensa_opcode opcode,
5105 int opnd,
5106 bool is_abs_literal)
5107 {
5108 reloc->source_sec = source_sec;
5109 reloc->r_rel = *r_rel;
5110 reloc->opcode = opcode;
5111 reloc->opnd = opnd;
5112 reloc->is_null = false;
5113 reloc->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5114 }
5115
5116
5117 /* Find the source_reloc for a particular source offset and relocation
5118 type. Note that the array is sorted by _target_ offset, so this is
5119 just a linear search. */
5120
5121 static source_reloc *
5122 find_source_reloc (source_reloc *src_relocs,
5123 int src_count,
5124 asection *sec,
5125 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
5126 {
5127 int i;
5128
5129 for (i = 0; i < src_count; i++)
5130 {
5131 if (src_relocs[i].source_sec == sec
5132 && src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset == irel->r_offset
5133 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_info)
5134 == ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
5135 return &src_relocs[i];
5136 }
5137
5138 return NULL;
5139 }
5140
5141
5142 static int
5143 source_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
5144 {
5145 const source_reloc *a = (const source_reloc *) ap;
5146 const source_reloc *b = (const source_reloc *) bp;
5147
5148 if (a->r_rel.target_offset != b->r_rel.target_offset)
5149 return (a->r_rel.target_offset - b->r_rel.target_offset);
5150
5151 /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
5152 but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
5153 from behaving differently with different implementations.
5154 Without the code below we get correct but different results
5155 on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8. We would like to always produce the
5156 same results no matter the host. */
5157
5158 if ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null))
5159 return ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null));
5160 return internal_reloc_compare (&a->r_rel.rela, &b->r_rel.rela);
5161 }
5162
5163 \f
5164 /* Literal values and value hash tables. */
5165
5166 /* Literals with the same value can be coalesced. The literal_value
5167 structure records the value of a literal: the "r_rel" field holds the
5168 information from the relocation on the literal (if there is one) and
5169 the "value" field holds the contents of the literal word itself.
5170
5171 The value_map structure records a literal value along with the
5172 location of a literal holding that value. The value_map hash table
5173 is indexed by the literal value, so that we can quickly check if a
5174 particular literal value has been seen before and is thus a candidate
5175 for coalescing. */
5176
5177 typedef struct literal_value_struct literal_value;
5178 typedef struct value_map_struct value_map;
5179 typedef struct value_map_hash_table_struct value_map_hash_table;
5180
5181 struct literal_value_struct
5182 {
5183 r_reloc r_rel;
5184 unsigned long value;
5185 bool is_abs_literal;
5186 };
5187
5188 struct value_map_struct
5189 {
5190 literal_value val; /* The literal value. */
5191 r_reloc loc; /* Location of the literal. */
5192 value_map *next;
5193 };
5194
5195 struct value_map_hash_table_struct
5196 {
5197 unsigned bucket_count;
5198 value_map **buckets;
5199 unsigned count;
5200 bool has_last_loc;
5201 r_reloc last_loc;
5202 };
5203
5204
5205 static void
5206 init_literal_value (literal_value *lit,
5207 const r_reloc *r_rel,
5208 unsigned long value,
5209 bool is_abs_literal)
5210 {
5211 lit->r_rel = *r_rel;
5212 lit->value = value;
5213 lit->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5214 }
5215
5216
5217 static bool
5218 literal_value_equal (const literal_value *src1,
5219 const literal_value *src2,
5220 bool final_static_link)
5221 {
5222 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h1, *h2;
5223
5224 if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel) != r_reloc_is_const (&src2->r_rel))
5225 return false;
5226
5227 if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel))
5228 return (src1->value == src2->value);
5229
5230 if (ELF32_R_TYPE (src1->r_rel.rela.r_info)
5231 != ELF32_R_TYPE (src2->r_rel.rela.r_info))
5232 return false;
5233
5234 if (src1->r_rel.target_offset != src2->r_rel.target_offset)
5235 return false;
5236
5237 if (src1->r_rel.virtual_offset != src2->r_rel.virtual_offset)
5238 return false;
5239
5240 if (src1->value != src2->value)
5241 return false;
5242
5243 /* Now check for the same section (if defined) or the same elf_hash
5244 (if undefined or weak). */
5245 h1 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src1->r_rel);
5246 h2 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src2->r_rel);
5247 if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src1->r_rel)
5248 && (final_static_link
5249 || ((!h1 || h1->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5250 && (!h2 || h2->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak))))
5251 {
5252 if (r_reloc_get_section (&src1->r_rel)
5253 != r_reloc_get_section (&src2->r_rel))
5254 return false;
5255 }
5256 else
5257 {
5258 /* Require that the hash entries (i.e., symbols) be identical. */
5259 if (h1 != h2 || h1 == 0)
5260 return false;
5261 }
5262
5263 if (src1->is_abs_literal != src2->is_abs_literal)
5264 return false;
5265
5266 return true;
5267 }
5268
5269
5270 /* Must be power of 2. */
5271 #define INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT 1024
5272
5273 static value_map_hash_table *
5274 value_map_hash_table_init (void)
5275 {
5276 value_map_hash_table *values;
5277
5278 values = (value_map_hash_table *)
5279 bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map_hash_table));
5280 values->bucket_count = INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT;
5281 values->count = 0;
5282 values->buckets = (value_map **)
5283 bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map *) * values->bucket_count);
5284 if (values->buckets == NULL)
5285 {
5286 free (values);
5287 return NULL;
5288 }
5289 values->has_last_loc = false;
5290
5291 return values;
5292 }
5293
5294
5295 static void
5296 value_map_hash_table_delete (value_map_hash_table *table)
5297 {
5298 free (table->buckets);
5299 free (table);
5300 }
5301
5302
5303 static unsigned
5304 hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma val)
5305 {
5306 return (val >> 2) + (val >> 10);
5307 }
5308
5309
5310 static unsigned
5311 literal_value_hash (const literal_value *src)
5312 {
5313 unsigned hash_val;
5314
5315 hash_val = hash_bfd_vma (src->value);
5316 if (!r_reloc_is_const (&src->r_rel))
5317 {
5318 void *sec_or_hash;
5319
5320 hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->is_abs_literal * 1000);
5321 hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.target_offset);
5322 hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.virtual_offset);
5323
5324 /* Now check for the same section and the same elf_hash. */
5325 if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src->r_rel))
5326 sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_section (&src->r_rel);
5327 else
5328 sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src->r_rel);
5329 hash_val += hash_bfd_vma ((bfd_vma) (size_t) sec_or_hash);
5330 }
5331 return hash_val;
5332 }
5333
5334
5335 /* Check if the specified literal_value has been seen before. */
5336
5337 static value_map *
5338 value_map_get_cached_value (value_map_hash_table *map,
5339 const literal_value *val,
5340 bool final_static_link)
5341 {
5342 value_map *map_e;
5343 value_map *bucket;
5344 unsigned idx;
5345
5346 idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5347 idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5348 bucket = map->buckets[idx];
5349 for (map_e = bucket; map_e; map_e = map_e->next)
5350 {
5351 if (literal_value_equal (&map_e->val, val, final_static_link))
5352 return map_e;
5353 }
5354 return NULL;
5355 }
5356
5357
5358 /* Record a new literal value. It is illegal to call this if VALUE
5359 already has an entry here. */
5360
5361 static value_map *
5362 add_value_map (value_map_hash_table *map,
5363 const literal_value *val,
5364 const r_reloc *loc,
5365 bool final_static_link)
5366 {
5367 value_map **bucket_p;
5368 unsigned idx;
5369
5370 value_map *val_e = (value_map *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map));
5371 if (val_e == NULL)
5372 {
5373 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
5374 return NULL;
5375 }
5376
5377 BFD_ASSERT (!value_map_get_cached_value (map, val, final_static_link));
5378 val_e->val = *val;
5379 val_e->loc = *loc;
5380
5381 idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5382 idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5383 bucket_p = &map->buckets[idx];
5384
5385 val_e->next = *bucket_p;
5386 *bucket_p = val_e;
5387 map->count++;
5388 /* FIXME: Consider resizing the hash table if we get too many entries. */
5389
5390 return val_e;
5391 }
5392
5393 \f
5394 /* Lists of text actions (ta_) for narrowing, widening, longcall
5395 conversion, space fill, code & literal removal, etc. */
5396
5397 /* The following text actions are generated:
5398
5399 "ta_remove_insn" remove an instruction or instructions
5400 "ta_remove_longcall" convert longcall to call
5401 "ta_convert_longcall" convert longcall to nop/call
5402 "ta_narrow_insn" narrow a wide instruction
5403 "ta_widen" widen a narrow instruction
5404 "ta_fill" add fill or remove fill
5405 removed < 0 is a fill; branches to the fill address will be
5406 changed to address + fill size (e.g., address - removed)
5407 removed >= 0 branches to the fill address will stay unchanged
5408 "ta_remove_literal" remove a literal; this action is
5409 indicated when a literal is removed
5410 or replaced.
5411 "ta_add_literal" insert a new literal; this action is
5412 indicated when a literal has been moved.
5413 It may use a virtual_offset because
5414 multiple literals can be placed at the
5415 same location.
5416
5417 For each of these text actions, we also record the number of bytes
5418 removed by performing the text action. In the case of a "ta_widen"
5419 or a "ta_fill" that adds space, the removed_bytes will be negative. */
5420
5421 typedef struct text_action_struct text_action;
5422 typedef struct text_action_list_struct text_action_list;
5423 typedef enum text_action_enum_t text_action_t;
5424
5425 enum text_action_enum_t
5426 {
5427 ta_none,
5428 ta_remove_insn, /* removed = -size */
5429 ta_remove_longcall, /* removed = -size */
5430 ta_convert_longcall, /* removed = 0 */
5431 ta_narrow_insn, /* removed = -1 */
5432 ta_widen_insn, /* removed = +1 */
5433 ta_fill, /* removed = +size */
5434 ta_remove_literal,
5435 ta_add_literal
5436 };
5437
5438
5439 /* Structure for a text action record. */
5440 struct text_action_struct
5441 {
5442 text_action_t action;
5443 asection *sec; /* Optional */
5444 bfd_vma offset;
5445 bfd_vma virtual_offset; /* Zero except for adding literals. */
5446 int removed_bytes;
5447 literal_value value; /* Only valid when adding literals. */
5448 };
5449
5450 struct removal_by_action_entry_struct
5451 {
5452 bfd_vma offset;
5453 int removed;
5454 int eq_removed;
5455 int eq_removed_before_fill;
5456 };
5457 typedef struct removal_by_action_entry_struct removal_by_action_entry;
5458
5459 struct removal_by_action_map_struct
5460 {
5461 unsigned n_entries;
5462 removal_by_action_entry *entry;
5463 };
5464 typedef struct removal_by_action_map_struct removal_by_action_map;
5465
5466
5467 /* List of all of the actions taken on a text section. */
5468 struct text_action_list_struct
5469 {
5470 unsigned count;
5471 splay_tree tree;
5472 removal_by_action_map map;
5473 };
5474
5475
5476 static text_action *
5477 find_fill_action (text_action_list *l, asection *sec, bfd_vma offset)
5478 {
5479 text_action a;
5480
5481 /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section. */
5482 if (sec->size == offset)
5483 return NULL;
5484
5485 a.offset = offset;
5486 a.action = ta_fill;
5487
5488 splay_tree_node node = splay_tree_lookup (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)&a);
5489 if (node)
5490 return (text_action *)node->value;
5491 return NULL;
5492 }
5493
5494
5495 static int
5496 compute_removed_action_diff (const text_action *ta,
5497 asection *sec,
5498 bfd_vma offset,
5499 int removed,
5500 int removable_space)
5501 {
5502 int new_removed;
5503 int current_removed = 0;
5504
5505 if (ta)
5506 current_removed = ta->removed_bytes;
5507
5508 BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->offset == offset);
5509 BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->action == ta_fill);
5510
5511 /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section. Clean this up. */
5512 if (sec->size == offset)
5513 new_removed = removable_space - 0;
5514 else
5515 {
5516 int space;
5517 int added = -removed - current_removed;
5518 /* Ignore multiples of the section alignment. */
5519 added = ((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & added;
5520 new_removed = (-added);
5521
5522 /* Modify for removable. */
5523 space = removable_space - new_removed;
5524 new_removed = (removable_space
5525 - (((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & space));
5526 }
5527 return (new_removed - current_removed);
5528 }
5529
5530
5531 static void
5532 adjust_fill_action (text_action *ta, int fill_diff)
5533 {
5534 ta->removed_bytes += fill_diff;
5535 }
5536
5537
5538 static int
5539 text_action_compare (splay_tree_key a, splay_tree_key b)
5540 {
5541 text_action *pa = (text_action *)a;
5542 text_action *pb = (text_action *)b;
5543 static const int action_priority[] =
5544 {
5545 [ta_fill] = 0,
5546 [ta_none] = 1,
5547 [ta_convert_longcall] = 2,
5548 [ta_narrow_insn] = 3,
5549 [ta_remove_insn] = 4,
5550 [ta_remove_longcall] = 5,
5551 [ta_remove_literal] = 6,
5552 [ta_widen_insn] = 7,
5553 [ta_add_literal] = 8,
5554 };
5555
5556 if (pa->offset == pb->offset)
5557 {
5558 if (pa->action == pb->action)
5559 return 0;
5560 return action_priority[pa->action] - action_priority[pb->action];
5561 }
5562 else
5563 return pa->offset < pb->offset ? -1 : 1;
5564 }
5565
5566 static text_action *
5567 action_first (text_action_list *action_list)
5568 {
5569 splay_tree_node node = splay_tree_min (action_list->tree);
5570 return node ? (text_action *)node->value : NULL;
5571 }
5572
5573 static text_action *
5574 action_next (text_action_list *action_list, text_action *action)
5575 {
5576 splay_tree_node node = splay_tree_successor (action_list->tree,
5577 (splay_tree_key)action);
5578 return node ? (text_action *)node->value : NULL;
5579 }
5580
5581 /* Add a modification action to the text. For the case of adding or
5582 removing space, modify any current fill and assume that
5583 "unreachable_space" bytes can be freely contracted. Note that a
5584 negative removed value is a fill. */
5585
5586 static void
5587 text_action_add (text_action_list *l,
5588 text_action_t action,
5589 asection *sec,
5590 bfd_vma offset,
5591 int removed)
5592 {
5593 text_action *ta;
5594 text_action a;
5595
5596 /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section. */
5597 if (action == ta_fill && sec->size == offset)
5598 return;
5599
5600 /* It is not necessary to fill 0 bytes. */
5601 if (action == ta_fill && removed == 0)
5602 return;
5603
5604 a.action = action;
5605 a.offset = offset;
5606
5607 if (action == ta_fill)
5608 {
5609 splay_tree_node node = splay_tree_lookup (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)&a);
5610
5611 if (node)
5612 {
5613 ta = (text_action *)node->value;
5614 ta->removed_bytes += removed;
5615 return;
5616 }
5617 }
5618 else
5619 BFD_ASSERT (splay_tree_lookup (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)&a) == NULL);
5620
5621 ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5622 ta->action = action;
5623 ta->sec = sec;
5624 ta->offset = offset;
5625 ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5626 splay_tree_insert (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)ta, (splay_tree_value)ta);
5627 ++l->count;
5628 }
5629
5630
5631 static void
5632 text_action_add_literal (text_action_list *l,
5633 text_action_t action,
5634 const r_reloc *loc,
5635 const literal_value *value,
5636 int removed)
5637 {
5638 text_action *ta;
5639 asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (loc);
5640 bfd_vma offset = loc->target_offset;
5641 bfd_vma virtual_offset = loc->virtual_offset;
5642
5643 BFD_ASSERT (action == ta_add_literal);
5644
5645 /* Create a new record and fill it up. */
5646 ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5647 ta->action = action;
5648 ta->sec = sec;
5649 ta->offset = offset;
5650 ta->virtual_offset = virtual_offset;
5651 ta->value = *value;
5652 ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5653
5654 BFD_ASSERT (splay_tree_lookup (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)ta) == NULL);
5655 splay_tree_insert (l->tree, (splay_tree_key)ta, (splay_tree_value)ta);
5656 ++l->count;
5657 }
5658
5659
5660 /* Find the total offset adjustment for the relaxations specified by
5661 text_actions, beginning from a particular starting action. This is
5662 typically used from offset_with_removed_text to search an entire list of
5663 actions, but it may also be called directly when adjusting adjacent offsets
5664 so that each search may begin where the previous one left off. */
5665
5666 static int
5667 removed_by_actions (text_action_list *action_list,
5668 text_action **p_start_action,
5669 bfd_vma offset,
5670 bool before_fill)
5671 {
5672 text_action *r;
5673 int removed = 0;
5674
5675 r = *p_start_action;
5676 if (r)
5677 {
5678 splay_tree_node node = splay_tree_lookup (action_list->tree,
5679 (splay_tree_key)r);
5680 BFD_ASSERT (node != NULL && r == (text_action *)node->value);
5681 }
5682
5683 while (r)
5684 {
5685 if (r->offset > offset)
5686 break;
5687
5688 if (r->offset == offset
5689 && (before_fill || r->action != ta_fill || r->removed_bytes >= 0))
5690 break;
5691
5692 removed += r->removed_bytes;
5693
5694 r = action_next (action_list, r);
5695 }
5696
5697 *p_start_action = r;
5698 return removed;
5699 }
5700
5701
5702 static bfd_vma
5703 offset_with_removed_text (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5704 {
5705 text_action *r = action_first (action_list);
5706
5707 return offset - removed_by_actions (action_list, &r, offset, false);
5708 }
5709
5710
5711 static unsigned
5712 action_list_count (text_action_list *action_list)
5713 {
5714 return action_list->count;
5715 }
5716
5717 typedef struct map_action_fn_context_struct map_action_fn_context;
5718 struct map_action_fn_context_struct
5719 {
5720 int removed;
5721 removal_by_action_map map;
5722 bool eq_complete;
5723 };
5724
5725 static int
5726 map_action_fn (splay_tree_node node, void *p)
5727 {
5728 map_action_fn_context *ctx = p;
5729 text_action *r = (text_action *)node->value;
5730 removal_by_action_entry *ientry = ctx->map.entry + ctx->map.n_entries;
5731
5732 if (ctx->map.n_entries && (ientry - 1)->offset == r->offset)
5733 {
5734 --ientry;
5735 }
5736 else
5737 {
5738 ++ctx->map.n_entries;
5739 ctx->eq_complete = false;
5740 ientry->offset = r->offset;
5741 ientry->eq_removed_before_fill = ctx->removed;
5742 }
5743
5744 if (!ctx->eq_complete)
5745 {
5746 if (r->action != ta_fill || r->removed_bytes >= 0)
5747 {
5748 ientry->eq_removed = ctx->removed;
5749 ctx->eq_complete = true;
5750 }
5751 else
5752 ientry->eq_removed = ctx->removed + r->removed_bytes;
5753 }
5754
5755 ctx->removed += r->removed_bytes;
5756 ientry->removed = ctx->removed;
5757 return 0;
5758 }
5759
5760 static void
5761 map_removal_by_action (text_action_list *action_list)
5762 {
5763 map_action_fn_context ctx;
5764
5765 ctx.removed = 0;
5766 ctx.map.n_entries = 0;
5767 ctx.map.entry = bfd_malloc (action_list_count (action_list) *
5768 sizeof (removal_by_action_entry));
5769 ctx.eq_complete = false;
5770
5771 splay_tree_foreach (action_list->tree, map_action_fn, &ctx);
5772 action_list->map = ctx.map;
5773 }
5774
5775 static int
5776 removed_by_actions_map (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset,
5777 bool before_fill)
5778 {
5779 unsigned a, b;
5780
5781 if (!action_list->map.entry)
5782 map_removal_by_action (action_list);
5783
5784 if (!action_list->map.n_entries)
5785 return 0;
5786
5787 a = 0;
5788 b = action_list->map.n_entries;
5789
5790 while (b - a > 1)
5791 {
5792 unsigned c = (a + b) / 2;
5793
5794 if (action_list->map.entry[c].offset <= offset)
5795 a = c;
5796 else
5797 b = c;
5798 }
5799
5800 if (action_list->map.entry[a].offset < offset)
5801 {
5802 return action_list->map.entry[a].removed;
5803 }
5804 else if (action_list->map.entry[a].offset == offset)
5805 {
5806 return before_fill ?
5807 action_list->map.entry[a].eq_removed_before_fill :
5808 action_list->map.entry[a].eq_removed;
5809 }
5810 else
5811 {
5812 return 0;
5813 }
5814 }
5815
5816 static bfd_vma
5817 offset_with_removed_text_map (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5818 {
5819 int removed = removed_by_actions_map (action_list, offset, false);
5820 return offset - removed;
5821 }
5822
5823
5824 /* The find_insn_action routine will only find non-fill actions. */
5825
5826 static text_action *
5827 find_insn_action (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5828 {
5829 static const text_action_t action[] =
5830 {
5831 ta_convert_longcall,
5832 ta_remove_longcall,
5833 ta_widen_insn,
5834 ta_narrow_insn,
5835 ta_remove_insn,
5836 };
5837 text_action a;
5838 unsigned i;
5839
5840 a.offset = offset;
5841 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (action) / sizeof (*action); ++i)
5842 {
5843 splay_tree_node node;
5844
5845 a.action = action[i];
5846 node = splay_tree_lookup (action_list->tree, (splay_tree_key)&a);
5847 if (node)
5848 return (text_action *)node->value;
5849 }
5850 return NULL;
5851 }
5852
5853
5854 #if DEBUG
5855
5856 static void
5857 print_action (FILE *fp, text_action *r)
5858 {
5859 const char *t = "unknown";
5860 switch (r->action)
5861 {
5862 case ta_remove_insn:
5863 t = "remove_insn"; break;
5864 case ta_remove_longcall:
5865 t = "remove_longcall"; break;
5866 case ta_convert_longcall:
5867 t = "convert_longcall"; break;
5868 case ta_narrow_insn:
5869 t = "narrow_insn"; break;
5870 case ta_widen_insn:
5871 t = "widen_insn"; break;
5872 case ta_fill:
5873 t = "fill"; break;
5874 case ta_none:
5875 t = "none"; break;
5876 case ta_remove_literal:
5877 t = "remove_literal"; break;
5878 case ta_add_literal:
5879 t = "add_literal"; break;
5880 }
5881
5882 fprintf (fp, "%s: %s[0x%lx] \"%s\" %d\n",
5883 r->sec->owner->filename,
5884 r->sec->name, (unsigned long) r->offset, t, r->removed_bytes);
5885 }
5886
5887 static int
5888 print_action_list_fn (splay_tree_node node, void *p)
5889 {
5890 text_action *r = (text_action *)node->value;
5891
5892 print_action (p, r);
5893 return 0;
5894 }
5895
5896 static void
5897 print_action_list (FILE *fp, text_action_list *action_list)
5898 {
5899 fprintf (fp, "Text Action\n");
5900 splay_tree_foreach (action_list->tree, print_action_list_fn, fp);
5901 }
5902
5903 #endif /* DEBUG */
5904
5905 \f
5906 /* Lists of literals being coalesced or removed. */
5907
5908 /* In the usual case, the literal identified by "from" is being
5909 coalesced with another literal identified by "to". If the literal is
5910 unused and is being removed altogether, "to.abfd" will be NULL.
5911 The removed_literal entries are kept on a per-section list, sorted
5912 by the "from" offset field. */
5913
5914 typedef struct removed_literal_struct removed_literal;
5915 typedef struct removed_literal_map_entry_struct removed_literal_map_entry;
5916 typedef struct removed_literal_list_struct removed_literal_list;
5917
5918 struct removed_literal_struct
5919 {
5920 r_reloc from;
5921 r_reloc to;
5922 removed_literal *next;
5923 };
5924
5925 struct removed_literal_map_entry_struct
5926 {
5927 bfd_vma addr;
5928 removed_literal *literal;
5929 };
5930
5931 struct removed_literal_list_struct
5932 {
5933 removed_literal *head;
5934 removed_literal *tail;
5935
5936 unsigned n_map;
5937 removed_literal_map_entry *map;
5938 };
5939
5940
5941 /* Record that the literal at "from" is being removed. If "to" is not
5942 NULL, the "from" literal is being coalesced with the "to" literal. */
5943
5944 static void
5945 add_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list,
5946 const r_reloc *from,
5947 const r_reloc *to)
5948 {
5949 removed_literal *r, *new_r, *next_r;
5950
5951 new_r = (removed_literal *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (removed_literal));
5952
5953 new_r->from = *from;
5954 if (to)
5955 new_r->to = *to;
5956 else
5957 new_r->to.abfd = NULL;
5958 new_r->next = NULL;
5959
5960 r = removed_list->head;
5961 if (r == NULL)
5962 {
5963 removed_list->head = new_r;
5964 removed_list->tail = new_r;
5965 }
5966 /* Special check for common case of append. */
5967 else if (removed_list->tail->from.target_offset < from->target_offset)
5968 {
5969 removed_list->tail->next = new_r;
5970 removed_list->tail = new_r;
5971 }
5972 else
5973 {
5974 while (r->from.target_offset < from->target_offset && r->next)
5975 {
5976 r = r->next;
5977 }
5978 next_r = r->next;
5979 r->next = new_r;
5980 new_r->next = next_r;
5981 if (next_r == NULL)
5982 removed_list->tail = new_r;
5983 }
5984 }
5985
5986 static void
5987 map_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list)
5988 {
5989 unsigned n_map = 0;
5990 unsigned i;
5991 removed_literal_map_entry *map = NULL;
5992 removed_literal *r = removed_list->head;
5993
5994 for (i = 0; r; ++i, r = r->next)
5995 {
5996 if (i == n_map)
5997 {
5998 n_map = (n_map * 2) + 2;
5999 map = bfd_realloc (map, n_map * sizeof (*map));
6000 }
6001 map[i].addr = r->from.target_offset;
6002 map[i].literal = r;
6003 }
6004 removed_list->map = map;
6005 removed_list->n_map = i;
6006 }
6007
6008 static int
6009 removed_literal_compare (const void *a, const void *b)
6010 {
6011 const bfd_vma *key = a;
6012 const removed_literal_map_entry *memb = b;
6013
6014 if (*key == memb->addr)
6015 return 0;
6016 else
6017 return *key < memb->addr ? -1 : 1;
6018 }
6019
6020 /* Check if the list of removed literals contains an entry for the
6021 given address. Return the entry if found. */
6022
6023 static removed_literal *
6024 find_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list, bfd_vma addr)
6025 {
6026 removed_literal_map_entry *p;
6027 removed_literal *r = NULL;
6028
6029 if (removed_list->map == NULL)
6030 map_removed_literal (removed_list);
6031
6032 if (removed_list->map != NULL)
6033 {
6034 p = bsearch (&addr, removed_list->map, removed_list->n_map,
6035 sizeof (*removed_list->map), removed_literal_compare);
6036 if (p)
6037 {
6038 while (p != removed_list->map && (p - 1)->addr == addr)
6039 --p;
6040 r = p->literal;
6041 }
6042 }
6043 return r;
6044 }
6045
6046
6047 #if DEBUG
6048
6049 static void
6050 print_removed_literals (FILE *fp, removed_literal_list *removed_list)
6051 {
6052 removed_literal *r;
6053 r = removed_list->head;
6054 if (r)
6055 fprintf (fp, "Removed Literals\n");
6056 for (; r != NULL; r = r->next)
6057 {
6058 print_r_reloc (fp, &r->from);
6059 fprintf (fp, " => ");
6060 if (r->to.abfd == NULL)
6061 fprintf (fp, "REMOVED");
6062 else
6063 print_r_reloc (fp, &r->to);
6064 fprintf (fp, "\n");
6065 }
6066 }
6067
6068 #endif /* DEBUG */
6069
6070 \f
6071 /* Per-section data for relaxation. */
6072
6073 typedef struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct reloc_bfd_fix;
6074
6075 struct xtensa_relax_info_struct
6076 {
6077 bool is_relaxable_literal_section;
6078 bool is_relaxable_asm_section;
6079 int visited; /* Number of times visited. */
6080
6081 source_reloc *src_relocs; /* Array[src_count]. */
6082 int src_count;
6083 int src_next; /* Next src_relocs entry to assign. */
6084
6085 removed_literal_list removed_list;
6086 text_action_list action_list;
6087
6088 reloc_bfd_fix *fix_list;
6089 reloc_bfd_fix *fix_array;
6090 unsigned fix_array_count;
6091
6092 /* Support for expanding the reloc array that is stored
6093 in the section structure. If the relocations have been
6094 reallocated, the newly allocated relocations will be referenced
6095 here along with the actual size allocated. The relocation
6096 count will always be found in the section structure. */
6097 Elf_Internal_Rela *allocated_relocs;
6098 unsigned relocs_count;
6099 unsigned allocated_relocs_count;
6100 };
6101
6102 struct elf_xtensa_section_data
6103 {
6104 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
6105 xtensa_relax_info relax_info;
6106 };
6107
6108
6109 static bool
6110 elf_xtensa_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
6111 {
6112 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
6113 {
6114 struct elf_xtensa_section_data *sdata;
6115 size_t amt = sizeof (*sdata);
6116
6117 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6118 if (sdata == NULL)
6119 return false;
6120 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
6121 }
6122
6123 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
6124 }
6125
6126
6127 static xtensa_relax_info *
6128 get_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
6129 {
6130 struct elf_xtensa_section_data *section_data;
6131
6132 /* No info available if no section or if it is an output section. */
6133 if (!sec || sec == sec->output_section)
6134 return NULL;
6135
6136 section_data = (struct elf_xtensa_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec);
6137 return &section_data->relax_info;
6138 }
6139
6140
6141 static void
6142 init_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
6143 {
6144 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6145
6146 relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = false;
6147 relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = false;
6148 relax_info->visited = 0;
6149
6150 relax_info->src_relocs = NULL;
6151 relax_info->src_count = 0;
6152 relax_info->src_next = 0;
6153
6154 relax_info->removed_list.head = NULL;
6155 relax_info->removed_list.tail = NULL;
6156
6157 relax_info->action_list.tree = splay_tree_new (text_action_compare,
6158 NULL, NULL);
6159 relax_info->action_list.map.n_entries = 0;
6160 relax_info->action_list.map.entry = NULL;
6161
6162 relax_info->fix_list = NULL;
6163 relax_info->fix_array = NULL;
6164 relax_info->fix_array_count = 0;
6165
6166 relax_info->allocated_relocs = NULL;
6167 relax_info->relocs_count = 0;
6168 relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = 0;
6169 }
6170
6171 \f
6172 /* Coalescing literals may require a relocation to refer to a section in
6173 a different input file, but the standard relocation information
6174 cannot express that. Instead, the reloc_bfd_fix structures are used
6175 to "fix" the relocations that refer to sections in other input files.
6176 These structures are kept on per-section lists. The "src_type" field
6177 records the relocation type in case there are multiple relocations on
6178 the same location. FIXME: This is ugly; an alternative might be to
6179 add new symbols with the "owner" field to some other input file. */
6180
6181 struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct
6182 {
6183 asection *src_sec;
6184 bfd_vma src_offset;
6185 unsigned src_type; /* Relocation type. */
6186
6187 asection *target_sec;
6188 bfd_vma target_offset;
6189 bool translated;
6190
6191 reloc_bfd_fix *next;
6192 };
6193
6194
6195 static reloc_bfd_fix *
6196 reloc_bfd_fix_init (asection *src_sec,
6197 bfd_vma src_offset,
6198 unsigned src_type,
6199 asection *target_sec,
6200 bfd_vma target_offset,
6201 bool translated)
6202 {
6203 reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
6204
6205 fix = (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix));
6206 fix->src_sec = src_sec;
6207 fix->src_offset = src_offset;
6208 fix->src_type = src_type;
6209 fix->target_sec = target_sec;
6210 fix->target_offset = target_offset;
6211 fix->translated = translated;
6212
6213 return fix;
6214 }
6215
6216
6217 static void
6218 add_fix (asection *src_sec, reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
6219 {
6220 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6221
6222 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (src_sec);
6223 fix->next = relax_info->fix_list;
6224 relax_info->fix_list = fix;
6225 }
6226
6227
6228 static int
6229 fix_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
6230 {
6231 const reloc_bfd_fix *a = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) ap;
6232 const reloc_bfd_fix *b = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) bp;
6233
6234 if (a->src_offset != b->src_offset)
6235 return (a->src_offset - b->src_offset);
6236 return (a->src_type - b->src_type);
6237 }
6238
6239
6240 static void
6241 cache_fix_array (asection *sec)
6242 {
6243 unsigned i, count = 0;
6244 reloc_bfd_fix *r;
6245 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6246
6247 if (relax_info == NULL)
6248 return;
6249 if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
6250 return;
6251
6252 for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
6253 count++;
6254
6255 relax_info->fix_array =
6256 (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix) * count);
6257 relax_info->fix_array_count = count;
6258
6259 r = relax_info->fix_list;
6260 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, r = r->next)
6261 {
6262 relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i] = *r;
6263 relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i].next = NULL;
6264 }
6265
6266 qsort (relax_info->fix_array, relax_info->fix_array_count,
6267 sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
6268 }
6269
6270
6271 static reloc_bfd_fix *
6272 get_bfd_fix (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, unsigned type)
6273 {
6274 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6275 reloc_bfd_fix *rv;
6276 reloc_bfd_fix key;
6277
6278 if (relax_info == NULL)
6279 return NULL;
6280 if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
6281 return NULL;
6282
6283 if (relax_info->fix_array == NULL)
6284 cache_fix_array (sec);
6285
6286 key.src_offset = offset;
6287 key.src_type = type;
6288 rv = bsearch (&key, relax_info->fix_array, relax_info->fix_array_count,
6289 sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
6290 return rv;
6291 }
6292
6293 \f
6294 /* Section caching. */
6295
6296 typedef struct section_cache_struct section_cache_t;
6297
6298 struct section_cache_struct
6299 {
6300 asection *sec;
6301
6302 bfd_byte *contents; /* Cache of the section contents. */
6303 bfd_size_type content_length;
6304
6305 property_table_entry *ptbl; /* Cache of the section property table. */
6306 unsigned pte_count;
6307
6308 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs; /* Cache of the section relocations. */
6309 unsigned reloc_count;
6310 };
6311
6312
6313 static void
6314 init_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6315 {
6316 memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (*sec_cache));
6317 }
6318
6319
6320 static void
6321 free_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6322 {
6323 if (sec_cache->sec)
6324 {
6325 release_contents (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->contents);
6326 release_internal_relocs (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->relocs);
6327 free (sec_cache->ptbl);
6328 }
6329 }
6330
6331
6332 static bool
6333 section_cache_section (section_cache_t *sec_cache,
6334 asection *sec,
6335 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6336 {
6337 bfd *abfd;
6338 property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
6339 int ptblsize = 0;
6340 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6341 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6342 bfd_size_type sec_size;
6343
6344 if (sec == NULL)
6345 return false;
6346 if (sec == sec_cache->sec)
6347 return true;
6348
6349 abfd = sec->owner;
6350 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6351
6352 /* Get the contents. */
6353 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6354 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6355 goto err;
6356
6357 /* Get the relocations. */
6358 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6359 link_info->keep_memory);
6360
6361 /* Get the entry table. */
6362 ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
6363 XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, false);
6364 if (ptblsize < 0)
6365 goto err;
6366
6367 /* Fill in the new section cache. */
6368 free_section_cache (sec_cache);
6369 init_section_cache (sec_cache);
6370
6371 sec_cache->sec = sec;
6372 sec_cache->contents = contents;
6373 sec_cache->content_length = sec_size;
6374 sec_cache->relocs = internal_relocs;
6375 sec_cache->reloc_count = sec->reloc_count;
6376 sec_cache->pte_count = ptblsize;
6377 sec_cache->ptbl = prop_table;
6378
6379 return true;
6380
6381 err:
6382 release_contents (sec, contents);
6383 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
6384 free (prop_table);
6385 return false;
6386 }
6387
6388 \f
6389 /* Extended basic blocks. */
6390
6391 /* An ebb_struct represents an Extended Basic Block. Within this
6392 range, we guarantee that all instructions are decodable, the
6393 property table entries are contiguous, and no property table
6394 specifies a segment that cannot have instructions moved. This
6395 structure contains caches of the contents, property table and
6396 relocations for the specified section for easy use. The range is
6397 specified by ranges of indices for the byte offset, property table
6398 offsets and relocation offsets. These must be consistent. */
6399
6400 typedef struct ebb_struct ebb_t;
6401
6402 struct ebb_struct
6403 {
6404 asection *sec;
6405
6406 bfd_byte *contents; /* Cache of the section contents. */
6407 bfd_size_type content_length;
6408
6409 property_table_entry *ptbl; /* Cache of the section property table. */
6410 unsigned pte_count;
6411
6412 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs; /* Cache of the section relocations. */
6413 unsigned reloc_count;
6414
6415 bfd_vma start_offset; /* Offset in section. */
6416 unsigned start_ptbl_idx; /* Offset in the property table. */
6417 unsigned start_reloc_idx; /* Offset in the relocations. */
6418
6419 bfd_vma end_offset;
6420 unsigned end_ptbl_idx;
6421 unsigned end_reloc_idx;
6422
6423 bool ends_section; /* Is this the last ebb in a section? */
6424
6425 /* The unreachable property table at the end of this set of blocks;
6426 NULL if the end is not an unreachable block. */
6427 property_table_entry *ends_unreachable;
6428 };
6429
6430
6431 enum ebb_target_enum
6432 {
6433 EBB_NO_ALIGN = 0,
6434 EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6435 EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6436 EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN,
6437 EBB_REQUIRE_ALIGN
6438 };
6439
6440
6441 /* proposed_action_struct is similar to the text_action_struct except
6442 that is represents a potential transformation, not one that will
6443 occur. We build a list of these for an extended basic block
6444 and use them to compute the actual actions desired. We must be
6445 careful that the entire set of actual actions we perform do not
6446 break any relocations that would fit if the actions were not
6447 performed. */
6448
6449 typedef struct proposed_action_struct proposed_action;
6450
6451 struct proposed_action_struct
6452 {
6453 enum ebb_target_enum align_type; /* for the target alignment */
6454 bfd_vma alignment_pow;
6455 text_action_t action;
6456 bfd_vma offset;
6457 int removed_bytes;
6458 bool do_action; /* If false, then we will not perform the action. */
6459 };
6460
6461
6462 /* The ebb_constraint_struct keeps a set of proposed actions for an
6463 extended basic block. */
6464
6465 typedef struct ebb_constraint_struct ebb_constraint;
6466
6467 struct ebb_constraint_struct
6468 {
6469 ebb_t ebb;
6470 bool start_movable;
6471
6472 /* Bytes of extra space at the beginning if movable. */
6473 int start_extra_space;
6474
6475 enum ebb_target_enum start_align;
6476
6477 bool end_movable;
6478
6479 /* Bytes of extra space at the end if movable. */
6480 int end_extra_space;
6481
6482 unsigned action_count;
6483 unsigned action_allocated;
6484
6485 /* Array of proposed actions. */
6486 proposed_action *actions;
6487
6488 /* Action alignments -- one for each proposed action. */
6489 enum ebb_target_enum *action_aligns;
6490 };
6491
6492
6493 static void
6494 init_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6495 {
6496 memset (c, 0, sizeof (ebb_constraint));
6497 }
6498
6499
6500 static void
6501 free_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6502 {
6503 free (c->actions);
6504 }
6505
6506
6507 static void
6508 init_ebb (ebb_t *ebb,
6509 asection *sec,
6510 bfd_byte *contents,
6511 bfd_size_type content_length,
6512 property_table_entry *prop_table,
6513 unsigned ptblsize,
6514 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
6515 unsigned reloc_count)
6516 {
6517 memset (ebb, 0, sizeof (ebb_t));
6518 ebb->sec = sec;
6519 ebb->contents = contents;
6520 ebb->content_length = content_length;
6521 ebb->ptbl = prop_table;
6522 ebb->pte_count = ptblsize;
6523 ebb->relocs = internal_relocs;
6524 ebb->reloc_count = reloc_count;
6525 ebb->start_offset = 0;
6526 ebb->end_offset = ebb->content_length - 1;
6527 ebb->start_ptbl_idx = 0;
6528 ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptblsize;
6529 ebb->start_reloc_idx = 0;
6530 ebb->end_reloc_idx = reloc_count;
6531 }
6532
6533
6534 /* Extend the ebb to all decodable contiguous sections. The algorithm
6535 for building a basic block around an instruction is to push it
6536 forward until we hit the end of a section, an unreachable block or
6537 a block that cannot be transformed. Then we push it backwards
6538 searching for similar conditions. */
6539
6540 static bool extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *);
6541 static bool extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *);
6542 static bfd_size_type insn_block_decodable_len
6543 (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_size_type);
6544
6545 static bool
6546 extend_ebb_bounds (ebb_t *ebb)
6547 {
6548 if (!extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb))
6549 return false;
6550 if (!extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb))
6551 return false;
6552 return true;
6553 }
6554
6555
6556 static bool
6557 extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *ebb)
6558 {
6559 property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6560
6561 the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
6562
6563 /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode an instruction, (2) we are at
6564 the end of the property tables, (3) we hit a non-contiguous property
6565 table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region. */
6566
6567 while (1)
6568 {
6569 bfd_vma entry_end;
6570 bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6571
6572 entry_end = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma + the_entry->size;
6573 insn_block_len =
6574 insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6575 ebb->end_offset,
6576 entry_end - ebb->end_offset);
6577 if (insn_block_len != (entry_end - ebb->end_offset))
6578 {
6579 _bfd_error_handler
6580 /* xgettext:c-format */
6581 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): could not decode instruction; "
6582 "possible configuration mismatch"),
6583 ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec,
6584 (uint64_t) (ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len));
6585 return false;
6586 }
6587 ebb->end_offset += insn_block_len;
6588
6589 if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->sec->size)
6590 ebb->ends_section = true;
6591
6592 /* Update the reloc counter. */
6593 while (ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1 < ebb->reloc_count
6594 && (ebb->relocs[ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1].r_offset
6595 < ebb->end_offset))
6596 {
6597 ebb->end_reloc_idx++;
6598 }
6599
6600 if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6601 return true;
6602
6603 new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6604 if (((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0)
6605 || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6606 || ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6607 break;
6608
6609 if (the_entry->address + the_entry->size != new_entry->address)
6610 break;
6611
6612 the_entry = new_entry;
6613 ebb->end_ptbl_idx++;
6614 }
6615
6616 /* Quick check for an unreachable or end of file just at the end. */
6617 if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6618 {
6619 if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->content_length)
6620 ebb->ends_section = true;
6621 }
6622 else
6623 {
6624 new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6625 if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0
6626 && the_entry->address + the_entry->size == new_entry->address)
6627 ebb->ends_unreachable = new_entry;
6628 }
6629
6630 /* Any other ending requires exact alignment. */
6631 return true;
6632 }
6633
6634
6635 static bool
6636 extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *ebb)
6637 {
6638 property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6639
6640 the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
6641
6642 /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode the instructions in the current entry.
6643 (2) we are at the beginning of the property tables, (3) we hit a
6644 non-contiguous property table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region. */
6645
6646 while (1)
6647 {
6648 bfd_vma block_begin;
6649 bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6650
6651 block_begin = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
6652 insn_block_len =
6653 insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6654 block_begin,
6655 ebb->start_offset - block_begin);
6656 if (insn_block_len != ebb->start_offset - block_begin)
6657 {
6658 _bfd_error_handler
6659 /* xgettext:c-format */
6660 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): could not decode instruction; "
6661 "possible configuration mismatch"),
6662 ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec,
6663 (uint64_t) (ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len));
6664 return false;
6665 }
6666 ebb->start_offset -= insn_block_len;
6667
6668 /* Update the reloc counter. */
6669 while (ebb->start_reloc_idx > 0
6670 && (ebb->relocs[ebb->start_reloc_idx - 1].r_offset
6671 >= ebb->start_offset))
6672 {
6673 ebb->start_reloc_idx--;
6674 }
6675
6676 if (ebb->start_ptbl_idx == 0)
6677 return true;
6678
6679 new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx - 1];
6680 if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0
6681 || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6682 || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6683 return true;
6684 if (new_entry->address + new_entry->size != the_entry->address)
6685 return true;
6686
6687 the_entry = new_entry;
6688 ebb->start_ptbl_idx--;
6689 }
6690 return true;
6691 }
6692
6693
6694 static bfd_size_type
6695 insn_block_decodable_len (bfd_byte *contents,
6696 bfd_size_type content_len,
6697 bfd_vma block_offset,
6698 bfd_size_type block_len)
6699 {
6700 bfd_vma offset = block_offset;
6701
6702 while (offset < block_offset + block_len)
6703 {
6704 bfd_size_type insn_len = 0;
6705
6706 insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
6707 if (insn_len == 0)
6708 return (offset - block_offset);
6709 offset += insn_len;
6710 }
6711 return (offset - block_offset);
6712 }
6713
6714
6715 static void
6716 ebb_propose_action (ebb_constraint *c,
6717 enum ebb_target_enum align_type,
6718 bfd_vma alignment_pow,
6719 text_action_t action,
6720 bfd_vma offset,
6721 int removed_bytes,
6722 bool do_action)
6723 {
6724 proposed_action *act;
6725
6726 if (c->action_allocated <= c->action_count)
6727 {
6728 unsigned new_allocated, i;
6729 proposed_action *new_actions;
6730
6731 new_allocated = (c->action_count + 2) * 2;
6732 new_actions = (proposed_action *)
6733 bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (proposed_action) * new_allocated);
6734
6735 for (i = 0; i < c->action_count; i++)
6736 new_actions[i] = c->actions[i];
6737 free (c->actions);
6738 c->actions = new_actions;
6739 c->action_allocated = new_allocated;
6740 }
6741
6742 act = &c->actions[c->action_count];
6743 act->align_type = align_type;
6744 act->alignment_pow = alignment_pow;
6745 act->action = action;
6746 act->offset = offset;
6747 act->removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
6748 act->do_action = do_action;
6749
6750 c->action_count++;
6751 }
6752
6753 \f
6754 /* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols. */
6755
6756 /* During relaxation, we need to modify relocations, section contents,
6757 and symbol definitions, and we need to keep the original values from
6758 being reloaded from the input files, i.e., we need to "pin" the
6759 modified values in memory. We also want to continue to observe the
6760 setting of the "keep-memory" flag. The following functions wrap the
6761 standard BFD functions to take care of this for us. */
6762
6763 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
6764 retrieve_internal_relocs (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bool keep_memory)
6765 {
6766 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6767
6768 if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6769 return NULL;
6770
6771 internal_relocs = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
6772 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6773 internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
6774 (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL, keep_memory));
6775 return internal_relocs;
6776 }
6777
6778
6779 static void
6780 pin_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6781 {
6782 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
6783 }
6784
6785
6786 static void
6787 release_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6788 {
6789 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6790 free (internal_relocs);
6791 }
6792
6793
6794 static bfd_byte *
6795 retrieve_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bool keep_memory)
6796 {
6797 bfd_byte *contents;
6798 bfd_size_type sec_size;
6799
6800 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6801 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6802
6803 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6804 {
6805 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6806 {
6807 free (contents);
6808 return NULL;
6809 }
6810 if (keep_memory)
6811 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6812 }
6813 return contents;
6814 }
6815
6816
6817 static void
6818 pin_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6819 {
6820 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6821 }
6822
6823
6824 static void
6825 release_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6826 {
6827 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6828 free (contents);
6829 }
6830
6831
6832 static Elf_Internal_Sym *
6833 retrieve_local_syms (bfd *input_bfd)
6834 {
6835 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6836 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
6837 size_t locsymcount;
6838
6839 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
6840 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6841
6842 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6843 if (isymbuf == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
6844 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount, 0,
6845 NULL, NULL, NULL);
6846
6847 /* Save the symbols for this input file so they won't be read again. */
6848 if (isymbuf && isymbuf != (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents)
6849 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6850
6851 return isymbuf;
6852 }
6853
6854 \f
6855 /* Code for link-time relaxation. */
6856
6857 /* Initialization for relaxation: */
6858 static bool analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *);
6859 static bool find_relaxable_sections
6860 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, bool *);
6861 static bool collect_source_relocs
6862 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6863 static bool is_resolvable_asm_expansion
6864 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6865 bool *);
6866 static Elf_Internal_Rela *find_associated_l32r_irel
6867 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6868 static bool compute_text_actions
6869 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6870 static bool compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6871 static bool compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6872 typedef struct reloc_range_list_struct reloc_range_list;
6873 static bool check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit
6874 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *,
6875 reloc_range_list *, const ebb_constraint *,
6876 const xtensa_opcode *);
6877 static bool check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *);
6878 static void text_action_add_proposed
6879 (text_action_list *, const ebb_constraint *, asection *);
6880
6881 /* First pass: */
6882 static bool compute_removed_literals
6883 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, value_map_hash_table *);
6884 static Elf_Internal_Rela *get_irel_at_offset
6885 (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma);
6886 static bool is_removable_literal
6887 (const source_reloc *, int, const source_reloc *, int, asection *,
6888 property_table_entry *, int);
6889 static bool remove_dead_literal
6890 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela *,
6891 Elf_Internal_Rela *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int);
6892 static bool identify_literal_placement
6893 (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6894 value_map_hash_table *, bool *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, int,
6895 source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, section_cache_t *,
6896 bool);
6897 static bool relocations_reach (source_reloc *, int, const r_reloc *);
6898 static bool coalesce_shared_literal
6899 (asection *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, value_map *);
6900 static bool move_shared_literal
6901 (asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *,
6902 int, const r_reloc *, const literal_value *, section_cache_t *);
6903
6904 /* Second pass: */
6905 static bool relax_section (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6906 static bool translate_section_fixes (asection *);
6907 static bool translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *);
6908 static asection *translate_reloc (const r_reloc *, r_reloc *, asection *);
6909 static void shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections
6910 (struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6911 static bool move_literal
6912 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *, bfd_vma, bfd_byte *,
6913 xtensa_relax_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela **, const literal_value *);
6914 static bool relax_property_section
6915 (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6916
6917 /* Third pass: */
6918 static bool relax_section_symbols (bfd *, asection *);
6919
6920
6921 static bool
6922 elf_xtensa_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6923 asection *sec,
6924 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6925 bool *again)
6926 {
6927 static value_map_hash_table *values = NULL;
6928 static bool relocations_analyzed = false;
6929 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6930
6931 if (!relocations_analyzed)
6932 {
6933 /* Do some overall initialization for relaxation. */
6934 values = value_map_hash_table_init ();
6935 if (values == NULL)
6936 return false;
6937 relaxing_section = true;
6938 if (!analyze_relocations (link_info))
6939 return false;
6940 relocations_analyzed = true;
6941 }
6942 *again = false;
6943
6944 /* Don't mess with linker-created sections. */
6945 if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6946 return true;
6947
6948 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6949 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info != NULL);
6950
6951 switch (relax_info->visited)
6952 {
6953 case 0:
6954 /* Note: It would be nice to fold this pass into
6955 analyze_relocations, but it is important for this step that the
6956 sections be examined in link order. */
6957 if (!compute_removed_literals (abfd, sec, link_info, values))
6958 return false;
6959 *again = true;
6960 break;
6961
6962 case 1:
6963 if (values)
6964 value_map_hash_table_delete (values);
6965 values = NULL;
6966 if (!relax_section (abfd, sec, link_info))
6967 return false;
6968 *again = true;
6969 break;
6970
6971 case 2:
6972 if (!relax_section_symbols (abfd, sec))
6973 return false;
6974 break;
6975 }
6976
6977 relax_info->visited++;
6978 return true;
6979 }
6980
6981 \f
6982 /* Initialization for relaxation. */
6983
6984 /* This function is called once at the start of relaxation. It scans
6985 all the input sections and marks the ones that are relaxable (i.e.,
6986 literal sections with L32R relocations against them), and then
6987 collects source_reloc information for all the relocations against
6988 those relaxable sections. During this process, it also detects
6989 longcalls, i.e., calls relaxed by the assembler into indirect
6990 calls, that can be optimized back into direct calls. Within each
6991 extended basic block (ebb) containing an optimized longcall, it
6992 computes a set of "text actions" that can be performed to remove
6993 the L32R associated with the longcall while optionally preserving
6994 branch target alignments. */
6995
6996 static bool
6997 analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6998 {
6999 bfd *abfd;
7000 asection *sec;
7001 bool is_relaxable = false;
7002
7003 /* Initialize the per-section relaxation info. */
7004 for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
7005 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7006 {
7007 init_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7008 }
7009
7010 /* Mark relaxable sections (and count relocations against each one). */
7011 for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
7012 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7013 {
7014 if (!find_relaxable_sections (abfd, sec, link_info, &is_relaxable))
7015 return false;
7016 }
7017
7018 /* Bail out if there are no relaxable sections. */
7019 if (!is_relaxable)
7020 return true;
7021
7022 /* Allocate space for source_relocs. */
7023 for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
7024 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7025 {
7026 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7027
7028 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7029 if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
7030 || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
7031 {
7032 relax_info->src_relocs = (source_reloc *)
7033 bfd_malloc (relax_info->src_count * sizeof (source_reloc));
7034 }
7035 else
7036 relax_info->src_count = 0;
7037 }
7038
7039 /* Collect info on relocations against each relaxable section. */
7040 for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
7041 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7042 {
7043 if (!collect_source_relocs (abfd, sec, link_info))
7044 return false;
7045 }
7046
7047 /* Compute the text actions. */
7048 for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link.next)
7049 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
7050 {
7051 if (!compute_text_actions (abfd, sec, link_info))
7052 return false;
7053 }
7054
7055 return true;
7056 }
7057
7058
7059 /* Find all the sections that might be relaxed. The motivation for
7060 this pass is that collect_source_relocs() needs to record _all_ the
7061 relocations that target each relaxable section. That is expensive
7062 and unnecessary unless the target section is actually going to be
7063 relaxed. This pass identifies all such sections by checking if
7064 they have L32Rs pointing to them. In the process, the total number
7065 of relocations targeting each section is also counted so that we
7066 know how much space to allocate for source_relocs against each
7067 relaxable literal section. */
7068
7069 static bool
7070 find_relaxable_sections (bfd *abfd,
7071 asection *sec,
7072 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7073 bool *is_relaxable_p)
7074 {
7075 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7076 bfd_byte *contents;
7077 bool ok = true;
7078 unsigned i;
7079 xtensa_relax_info *source_relax_info;
7080 bool is_l32r_reloc;
7081
7082 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
7083 link_info->keep_memory);
7084 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
7085 return ok;
7086
7087 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
7088 if (contents == NULL && sec->size != 0)
7089 {
7090 ok = false;
7091 goto error_return;
7092 }
7093
7094 source_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7095 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7096 {
7097 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7098 r_reloc r_rel;
7099 asection *target_sec;
7100 xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
7101
7102 /* If this section has not already been marked as "relaxable", and
7103 if it contains any ASM_EXPAND relocations (marking expanded
7104 longcalls) that can be optimized into direct calls, then mark
7105 the section as "relaxable". */
7106 if (source_relax_info
7107 && !source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section
7108 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
7109 {
7110 bool is_reachable = false;
7111 if (is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel,
7112 link_info, &is_reachable)
7113 && is_reachable)
7114 {
7115 source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = true;
7116 *is_relaxable_p = true;
7117 }
7118 }
7119
7120 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
7121 bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
7122
7123 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7124 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
7125 if (!target_relax_info)
7126 continue;
7127
7128 /* Count PC-relative operand relocations against the target section.
7129 Note: The conditions tested here must match the conditions under
7130 which init_source_reloc is called in collect_source_relocs(). */
7131 is_l32r_reloc = false;
7132 if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
7133 {
7134 xtensa_opcode opcode =
7135 get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7136 if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7137 {
7138 is_l32r_reloc = (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
7139 if (!is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info))
7140 || is_l32r_reloc)
7141 target_relax_info->src_count++;
7142 }
7143 }
7144
7145 if (is_l32r_reloc && r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
7146 {
7147 /* Mark the target section as relaxable. */
7148 target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = true;
7149 *is_relaxable_p = true;
7150 }
7151 }
7152
7153 error_return:
7154 release_contents (sec, contents);
7155 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7156 return ok;
7157 }
7158
7159
7160 /* Record _all_ the relocations that point to relaxable sections, and
7161 get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocs by either converting them to
7162 ASM_SIMPLIFY or by removing them. */
7163
7164 static bool
7165 collect_source_relocs (bfd *abfd,
7166 asection *sec,
7167 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7168 {
7169 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7170 bfd_byte *contents;
7171 bool ok = true;
7172 unsigned i;
7173 bfd_size_type sec_size;
7174
7175 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
7176 link_info->keep_memory);
7177 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
7178 return ok;
7179
7180 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7181 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
7182 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
7183 {
7184 ok = false;
7185 goto error_return;
7186 }
7187
7188 /* Record relocations against relaxable literal sections. */
7189 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7190 {
7191 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7192 r_reloc r_rel;
7193 asection *target_sec;
7194 xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
7195
7196 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
7197
7198 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7199 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
7200
7201 if (target_relax_info
7202 && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
7203 || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
7204 {
7205 xtensa_opcode opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
7206 int opnd = -1;
7207 bool is_abs_literal = false;
7208
7209 if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
7210 {
7211 /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
7212 and only PC-relative relocs matter here. However, we
7213 still need to record the opcode for literal
7214 coalescing. */
7215 opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7216 if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
7217 {
7218 is_abs_literal = true;
7219 opnd = 1;
7220 }
7221 else
7222 opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
7223 }
7224 else if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
7225 {
7226 opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7227 opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
7228 }
7229
7230 if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7231 {
7232 int src_next = target_relax_info->src_next++;
7233 source_reloc *s_reloc = &target_relax_info->src_relocs[src_next];
7234
7235 init_source_reloc (s_reloc, sec, &r_rel, opcode, opnd,
7236 is_abs_literal);
7237 }
7238 }
7239 }
7240
7241 /* Now get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocations. At this point, the
7242 src_relocs array for the target literal section may still be
7243 incomplete, but it must at least contain the entries for the L32R
7244 relocations associated with ASM_EXPANDs because they were just
7245 added in the preceding loop over the relocations. */
7246
7247 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7248 {
7249 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7250 bool is_reachable;
7251
7252 if (!is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel, link_info,
7253 &is_reachable))
7254 continue;
7255
7256 if (is_reachable)
7257 {
7258 Elf_Internal_Rela *l32r_irel;
7259 r_reloc r_rel;
7260 asection *target_sec;
7261 xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
7262
7263 /* Mark the source_reloc for the L32R so that it will be
7264 removed in compute_removed_literals(), along with the
7265 associated literal. */
7266 l32r_irel = find_associated_l32r_irel (abfd, sec, contents,
7267 irel, internal_relocs);
7268 if (l32r_irel == NULL)
7269 continue;
7270
7271 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, l32r_irel, contents, sec_size);
7272
7273 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7274 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
7275
7276 if (target_relax_info
7277 && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
7278 || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
7279 {
7280 source_reloc *s_reloc;
7281
7282 /* Search the source_relocs for the entry corresponding to
7283 the l32r_irel. Note: The src_relocs array is not yet
7284 sorted, but it wouldn't matter anyway because we're
7285 searching by source offset instead of target offset. */
7286 s_reloc = find_source_reloc (target_relax_info->src_relocs,
7287 target_relax_info->src_next,
7288 sec, l32r_irel);
7289 BFD_ASSERT (s_reloc);
7290 s_reloc->is_null = true;
7291 }
7292
7293 /* Convert this reloc to ASM_SIMPLIFY. */
7294 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
7295 R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY);
7296 l32r_irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7297
7298 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7299 }
7300 else
7301 {
7302 /* It is resolvable but doesn't reach. We resolve now
7303 by eliminating the relocation -- the call will remain
7304 expanded into L32R/CALLX. */
7305 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7306 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7307 }
7308 }
7309
7310 error_return:
7311 release_contents (sec, contents);
7312 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7313 return ok;
7314 }
7315
7316
7317 /* Return TRUE if the asm expansion can be resolved. Generally it can
7318 be resolved on a final link or when a partial link locates it in the
7319 same section as the target. Set "is_reachable" flag if the target of
7320 the call is within the range of a direct call, given the current VMA
7321 for this section and the target section. */
7322
7323 bool
7324 is_resolvable_asm_expansion (bfd *abfd,
7325 asection *sec,
7326 bfd_byte *contents,
7327 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
7328 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7329 bool *is_reachable_p)
7330 {
7331 asection *target_sec;
7332 asection *s;
7333 bfd_vma first_vma;
7334 bfd_vma last_vma;
7335 unsigned int first_align;
7336 unsigned int adjust;
7337 bfd_vma target_offset;
7338 r_reloc r_rel;
7339 xtensa_opcode opcode, direct_call_opcode;
7340 bfd_vma self_address;
7341 bfd_vma dest_address;
7342 bool uses_l32r;
7343 bfd_size_type sec_size;
7344
7345 *is_reachable_p = false;
7346
7347 if (contents == NULL)
7348 return false;
7349
7350 if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
7351 return false;
7352
7353 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7354 opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + irel->r_offset,
7355 sec_size - irel->r_offset, &uses_l32r);
7356 /* Optimization of longcalls that use CONST16 is not yet implemented. */
7357 if (!uses_l32r)
7358 return false;
7359
7360 direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
7361 if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7362 return false;
7363
7364 /* Check and see that the target resolves. */
7365 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
7366 if (!r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
7367 return false;
7368
7369 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7370 target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
7371
7372 /* If the target is in a shared library, then it doesn't reach. This
7373 isn't supposed to come up because the compiler should never generate
7374 non-PIC calls on systems that use shared libraries, but the linker
7375 shouldn't crash regardless. */
7376 if (!target_sec->output_section)
7377 return false;
7378
7379 /* For relocatable sections, we can only simplify when the output
7380 section of the target is the same as the output section of the
7381 source. */
7382 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
7383 && (target_sec->output_section != sec->output_section
7384 || is_reloc_sym_weak (abfd, irel)))
7385 return false;
7386
7387 if (target_sec->output_section != sec->output_section)
7388 {
7389 /* If the two sections are sufficiently far away that relaxation
7390 might take the call out of range, we can't simplify. For
7391 example, a positive displacement call into another memory
7392 could get moved to a lower address due to literal removal,
7393 but the destination won't move, and so the displacment might
7394 get larger.
7395
7396 If the displacement is negative, assume the destination could
7397 move as far back as the start of the output section. The
7398 self_address will be at least as far into the output section
7399 as it is prior to relaxation.
7400
7401 If the displacement is postive, assume the destination will be in
7402 it's pre-relaxed location (because relaxation only makes sections
7403 smaller). The self_address could go all the way to the beginning
7404 of the output section. */
7405
7406 dest_address = target_sec->output_section->vma;
7407 self_address = sec->output_section->vma;
7408
7409 if (sec->output_section->vma > target_sec->output_section->vma)
7410 self_address += sec->output_offset + irel->r_offset + 3;
7411 else
7412 dest_address += bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, target_sec->output_section);
7413 /* Call targets should be four-byte aligned. */
7414 dest_address = (dest_address + 3) & ~3;
7415 }
7416 else
7417 {
7418
7419 self_address = (sec->output_section->vma
7420 + sec->output_offset + irel->r_offset + 3);
7421 dest_address = (target_sec->output_section->vma
7422 + target_sec->output_offset + target_offset);
7423 }
7424
7425 /* Adjust addresses with alignments for the worst case to see if call insn
7426 can fit. Don't relax l32r + callx to call if the target can be out of
7427 range due to alignment.
7428 Caller and target addresses are highest and lowest address.
7429 Search all sections between caller and target, looking for max alignment.
7430 The adjustment is max alignment bytes. If the alignment at the lowest
7431 address is less than the adjustment, apply the adjustment to highest
7432 address. */
7433
7434 /* Start from lowest address.
7435 Lowest address aligmnet is from input section.
7436 Initial alignment (adjust) is from input section. */
7437 if (dest_address > self_address)
7438 {
7439 s = sec->output_section;
7440 last_vma = dest_address;
7441 first_align = sec->alignment_power;
7442 adjust = target_sec->alignment_power;
7443 }
7444 else
7445 {
7446 s = target_sec->output_section;
7447 last_vma = self_address;
7448 first_align = target_sec->alignment_power;
7449 adjust = sec->alignment_power;
7450 }
7451
7452 first_vma = s->vma;
7453
7454 /* Find the largest alignment in output section list. */
7455 for (; s && s->vma >= first_vma && s->vma <= last_vma ; s = s->next)
7456 {
7457 if (s->alignment_power > adjust)
7458 adjust = s->alignment_power;
7459 }
7460
7461 if (adjust > first_align)
7462 {
7463 /* Alignment may enlarge the range, adjust highest address. */
7464 adjust = 1 << adjust;
7465 if (dest_address > self_address)
7466 {
7467 dest_address += adjust;
7468 }
7469 else
7470 {
7471 self_address += adjust;
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 *is_reachable_p = pcrel_reloc_fits (direct_call_opcode, 0,
7476 self_address, dest_address);
7477
7478 if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS) !=
7479 (dest_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
7480 return false;
7481
7482 return true;
7483 }
7484
7485
7486 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
7487 find_associated_l32r_irel (bfd *abfd,
7488 asection *sec,
7489 bfd_byte *contents,
7490 Elf_Internal_Rela *other_irel,
7491 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7492 {
7493 unsigned i;
7494
7495 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7496 {
7497 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7498
7499 if (irel == other_irel)
7500 continue;
7501 if (irel->r_offset != other_irel->r_offset)
7502 continue;
7503 if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
7504 return irel;
7505 }
7506
7507 return NULL;
7508 }
7509
7510
7511 static xtensa_opcode *
7512 build_reloc_opcodes (bfd *abfd,
7513 asection *sec,
7514 bfd_byte *contents,
7515 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7516 {
7517 unsigned i;
7518 xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes =
7519 (xtensa_opcode *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_opcode) * sec->reloc_count);
7520 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7521 {
7522 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7523 reloc_opcodes[i] = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7524 }
7525 return reloc_opcodes;
7526 }
7527
7528 struct reloc_range_struct
7529 {
7530 bfd_vma addr;
7531 bool add; /* TRUE if start of a range, FALSE otherwise. */
7532 /* Original irel index in the array of relocations for a section. */
7533 unsigned irel_index;
7534 };
7535 typedef struct reloc_range_struct reloc_range;
7536
7537 typedef struct reloc_range_list_entry_struct reloc_range_list_entry;
7538 struct reloc_range_list_entry_struct
7539 {
7540 reloc_range_list_entry *next;
7541 reloc_range_list_entry *prev;
7542 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7543 xtensa_opcode opcode;
7544 int opnum;
7545 };
7546
7547 struct reloc_range_list_struct
7548 {
7549 /* The rest of the structure is only meaningful when ok is TRUE. */
7550 bool ok;
7551
7552 unsigned n_range; /* Number of range markers. */
7553 reloc_range *range; /* Sorted range markers. */
7554
7555 unsigned first; /* Index of a first range element in the list. */
7556 unsigned last; /* One past index of a last range element in the list. */
7557
7558 unsigned n_list; /* Number of list elements. */
7559 reloc_range_list_entry *reloc; /* */
7560 reloc_range_list_entry list_root;
7561 };
7562
7563 static int
7564 reloc_range_compare (const void *a, const void *b)
7565 {
7566 const reloc_range *ra = a;
7567 const reloc_range *rb = b;
7568
7569 if (ra->addr != rb->addr)
7570 return ra->addr < rb->addr ? -1 : 1;
7571 if (ra->add != rb->add)
7572 return ra->add ? -1 : 1;
7573 return 0;
7574 }
7575
7576 static void
7577 build_reloc_ranges (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
7578 bfd_byte *contents,
7579 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
7580 xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes,
7581 reloc_range_list *list)
7582 {
7583 unsigned i;
7584 size_t n = 0;
7585 size_t max_n = 0;
7586 reloc_range *ranges = NULL;
7587 reloc_range_list_entry *reloc =
7588 bfd_malloc (sec->reloc_count * sizeof (*reloc));
7589
7590 memset (list, 0, sizeof (*list));
7591 list->ok = true;
7592
7593 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7594 {
7595 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7596 int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
7597 reloc_howto_type *howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
7598 r_reloc r_rel;
7599
7600 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY
7601 || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL
7602 || !howto->pc_relative)
7603 continue;
7604
7605 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
7606 bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
7607
7608 if (r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel) != sec)
7609 continue;
7610
7611 if (n + 2 > max_n)
7612 {
7613 max_n = (max_n + 2) * 2;
7614 ranges = bfd_realloc (ranges, max_n * sizeof (*ranges));
7615 }
7616
7617 ranges[n].addr = irel->r_offset;
7618 ranges[n + 1].addr = r_rel.target_offset;
7619
7620 ranges[n].add = ranges[n].addr < ranges[n + 1].addr;
7621 ranges[n + 1].add = !ranges[n].add;
7622
7623 ranges[n].irel_index = i;
7624 ranges[n + 1].irel_index = i;
7625
7626 n += 2;
7627
7628 reloc[i].irel = irel;
7629
7630 /* Every relocation won't possibly be checked in the optimized version of
7631 check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit, so this needs to be done here. */
7632 if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
7633 {
7634 /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
7635 and only PC-relative relocs matter here. */
7636 }
7637 else
7638 {
7639 xtensa_opcode opcode;
7640 int opnum;
7641
7642 if (reloc_opcodes)
7643 opcode = reloc_opcodes[i];
7644 else
7645 opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7646
7647 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7648 {
7649 list->ok = false;
7650 break;
7651 }
7652
7653 opnum = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
7654 if (opnum == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7655 {
7656 list->ok = false;
7657 break;
7658 }
7659
7660 /* Record relocation opcode and opnum as we've calculated them
7661 anyway and they won't change. */
7662 reloc[i].opcode = opcode;
7663 reloc[i].opnum = opnum;
7664 }
7665 }
7666
7667 if (list->ok)
7668 {
7669 ranges = bfd_realloc (ranges, n * sizeof (*ranges));
7670 qsort (ranges, n, sizeof (*ranges), reloc_range_compare);
7671
7672 list->n_range = n;
7673 list->range = ranges;
7674 list->reloc = reloc;
7675 list->list_root.prev = &list->list_root;
7676 list->list_root.next = &list->list_root;
7677 }
7678 else
7679 {
7680 free (ranges);
7681 free (reloc);
7682 }
7683 }
7684
7685 static void reloc_range_list_append (reloc_range_list *list,
7686 unsigned irel_index)
7687 {
7688 reloc_range_list_entry *entry = list->reloc + irel_index;
7689
7690 entry->prev = list->list_root.prev;
7691 entry->next = &list->list_root;
7692 entry->prev->next = entry;
7693 entry->next->prev = entry;
7694 ++list->n_list;
7695 }
7696
7697 static void reloc_range_list_remove (reloc_range_list *list,
7698 unsigned irel_index)
7699 {
7700 reloc_range_list_entry *entry = list->reloc + irel_index;
7701
7702 entry->next->prev = entry->prev;
7703 entry->prev->next = entry->next;
7704 --list->n_list;
7705 }
7706
7707 /* Update relocation list object so that it lists all relocations that cross
7708 [first; last] range. Range bounds should not decrease with successive
7709 invocations. */
7710 static void reloc_range_list_update_range (reloc_range_list *list,
7711 bfd_vma first, bfd_vma last)
7712 {
7713 /* This should not happen: EBBs are iterated from lower addresses to higher.
7714 But even if that happens there's no need to break: just flush current list
7715 and start from scratch. */
7716 if ((list->last > 0 && list->range[list->last - 1].addr > last) ||
7717 (list->first > 0 && list->range[list->first - 1].addr >= first))
7718 {
7719 list->first = 0;
7720 list->last = 0;
7721 list->n_list = 0;
7722 list->list_root.next = &list->list_root;
7723 list->list_root.prev = &list->list_root;
7724 fprintf (stderr, "%s: move backwards requested\n", __func__);
7725 }
7726
7727 for (; list->last < list->n_range &&
7728 list->range[list->last].addr <= last; ++list->last)
7729 if (list->range[list->last].add)
7730 reloc_range_list_append (list, list->range[list->last].irel_index);
7731
7732 for (; list->first < list->n_range &&
7733 list->range[list->first].addr < first; ++list->first)
7734 if (!list->range[list->first].add)
7735 reloc_range_list_remove (list, list->range[list->first].irel_index);
7736 }
7737
7738 static void free_reloc_range_list (reloc_range_list *list)
7739 {
7740 free (list->range);
7741 free (list->reloc);
7742 }
7743
7744 /* The compute_text_actions function will build a list of potential
7745 transformation actions for code in the extended basic block of each
7746 longcall that is optimized to a direct call. From this list we
7747 generate a set of actions to actually perform that optimizes for
7748 space and, if not using size_opt, maintains branch target
7749 alignments.
7750
7751 These actions to be performed are placed on a per-section list.
7752 The actual changes are performed by relax_section() in the second
7753 pass. */
7754
7755 bool
7756 compute_text_actions (bfd *abfd,
7757 asection *sec,
7758 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7759 {
7760 xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes = NULL;
7761 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7762 bfd_byte *contents;
7763 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7764 bool ok = true;
7765 unsigned i;
7766 property_table_entry *prop_table = 0;
7767 int ptblsize = 0;
7768 bfd_size_type sec_size;
7769 reloc_range_list relevant_relocs;
7770
7771 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7772 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
7773 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->src_next == relax_info->src_count);
7774
7775 /* Do nothing if the section contains no optimized longcalls. */
7776 if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
7777 return ok;
7778
7779 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
7780 link_info->keep_memory);
7781
7782 if (internal_relocs)
7783 qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
7784 internal_reloc_compare);
7785
7786 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7787 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
7788 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
7789 {
7790 ok = false;
7791 goto error_return;
7792 }
7793
7794 ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
7795 XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, false);
7796 if (ptblsize < 0)
7797 {
7798 ok = false;
7799 goto error_return;
7800 }
7801
7802 /* Precompute the opcode for each relocation. */
7803 reloc_opcodes = build_reloc_opcodes (abfd, sec, contents, internal_relocs);
7804
7805 build_reloc_ranges (abfd, sec, contents, internal_relocs, reloc_opcodes,
7806 &relevant_relocs);
7807
7808 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7809 {
7810 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7811 bfd_vma r_offset;
7812 property_table_entry *the_entry;
7813 int ptbl_idx;
7814 ebb_t *ebb;
7815 ebb_constraint ebb_table;
7816 bfd_size_type simplify_size;
7817
7818 if (irel && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
7819 continue;
7820 r_offset = irel->r_offset;
7821
7822 simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (contents, sec_size, r_offset);
7823 if (simplify_size == 0)
7824 {
7825 _bfd_error_handler
7826 /* xgettext:c-format */
7827 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): could not decode instruction for "
7828 "XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY relocation; "
7829 "possible configuration mismatch"),
7830 sec->owner, sec, (uint64_t) r_offset);
7831 continue;
7832 }
7833
7834 /* If the instruction table is not around, then don't do this
7835 relaxation. */
7836 the_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
7837 sec->vma + irel->r_offset);
7838 if (the_entry == NULL || XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL)
7839 {
7840 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7841 ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset,
7842 0);
7843 continue;
7844 }
7845
7846 /* If the next longcall happens to be at the same address as an
7847 unreachable section of size 0, then skip forward. */
7848 ptbl_idx = the_entry - prop_table;
7849 while ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
7850 && the_entry->size == 0
7851 && ptbl_idx + 1 < ptblsize
7852 && (prop_table[ptbl_idx + 1].address
7853 == prop_table[ptbl_idx].address))
7854 {
7855 ptbl_idx++;
7856 the_entry++;
7857 }
7858
7859 if (the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM)
7860 /* NO_REORDER is OK */
7861 continue;
7862
7863 init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7864 ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
7865 init_ebb (ebb, sec, contents, sec_size, prop_table, ptblsize,
7866 internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count);
7867 ebb->start_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7868 ebb->end_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7869 ebb->start_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7870 ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7871 ebb->start_reloc_idx = i;
7872 ebb->end_reloc_idx = i;
7873
7874 if (!extend_ebb_bounds (ebb)
7875 || !compute_ebb_proposed_actions (&ebb_table)
7876 || !compute_ebb_actions (&ebb_table)
7877 || !check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (abfd, sec, contents,
7878 internal_relocs,
7879 &relevant_relocs,
7880 &ebb_table, reloc_opcodes)
7881 || !check_section_ebb_reduces (&ebb_table))
7882 {
7883 /* If anything goes wrong or we get unlucky and something does
7884 not fit, with our plan because of expansion between
7885 critical branches, just convert to a NOP. */
7886
7887 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7888 ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset, 0);
7889 i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7890 free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7891 continue;
7892 }
7893
7894 text_action_add_proposed (&relax_info->action_list, &ebb_table, sec);
7895
7896 /* Update the index so we do not go looking at the relocations
7897 we have already processed. */
7898 i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7899 free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7900 }
7901
7902 free_reloc_range_list (&relevant_relocs);
7903
7904 #if DEBUG
7905 if (action_list_count (&relax_info->action_list))
7906 print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
7907 #endif
7908
7909 error_return:
7910 release_contents (sec, contents);
7911 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7912 free (prop_table);
7913 free (reloc_opcodes);
7914
7915 return ok;
7916 }
7917
7918
7919 /* Do not widen an instruction if it is preceeded by a
7920 loop opcode. It might cause misalignment. */
7921
7922 static bool
7923 prev_instr_is_a_loop (bfd_byte *contents,
7924 bfd_size_type content_length,
7925 bfd_size_type offset)
7926 {
7927 xtensa_opcode prev_opcode;
7928
7929 if (offset < 3)
7930 return false;
7931 prev_opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset-3, 0);
7932 return (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, prev_opcode) == 1);
7933 }
7934
7935
7936 /* Find all of the possible actions for an extended basic block. */
7937
7938 bool
7939 compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
7940 {
7941 const ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
7942 unsigned rel_idx = ebb->start_reloc_idx;
7943 property_table_entry *entry, *start_entry, *end_entry;
7944 bfd_vma offset = 0;
7945 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
7946 xtensa_format fmt;
7947 static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
7948 static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
7949
7950 if (insnbuf == NULL)
7951 {
7952 insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7953 slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7954 }
7955
7956 start_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
7957 end_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
7958
7959 for (entry = start_entry; entry <= end_entry; entry++)
7960 {
7961 bfd_vma start_offset, end_offset;
7962 bfd_size_type insn_len;
7963
7964 start_offset = entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
7965 end_offset = entry->address + entry->size - ebb->sec->vma;
7966
7967 if (entry == start_entry)
7968 start_offset = ebb->start_offset;
7969 if (entry == end_entry)
7970 end_offset = ebb->end_offset;
7971 offset = start_offset;
7972
7973 if (offset == entry->address - ebb->sec->vma
7974 && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) != 0)
7975 {
7976 enum ebb_target_enum align_type = EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7977 BFD_ASSERT (offset != end_offset);
7978 if (offset == end_offset)
7979 return false;
7980
7981 insn_len = insn_decode_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
7982 offset);
7983 if (insn_len == 0)
7984 goto decode_error;
7985
7986 if (check_branch_target_aligned_address (offset, insn_len))
7987 align_type = EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7988
7989 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, align_type, 0,
7990 ta_none, offset, 0, true);
7991 }
7992
7993 while (offset != end_offset)
7994 {
7995 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7996 xtensa_opcode opcode;
7997
7998 while (rel_idx < ebb->end_reloc_idx
7999 && (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset < offset
8000 || (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset == offset
8001 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_info)
8002 != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY))))
8003 rel_idx++;
8004
8005 /* Check for longcall. */
8006 irel = &ebb->relocs[rel_idx];
8007 if (irel->r_offset == offset
8008 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
8009 {
8010 bfd_size_type simplify_size;
8011
8012 simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (ebb->contents,
8013 ebb->content_length,
8014 irel->r_offset);
8015 if (simplify_size == 0)
8016 goto decode_error;
8017
8018 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8019 ta_convert_longcall, offset, 0, true);
8020
8021 offset += simplify_size;
8022 continue;
8023 }
8024
8025 if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > ebb->content_length)
8026 goto decode_error;
8027 xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &ebb->contents[offset],
8028 ebb->content_length - offset);
8029 fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
8030 if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8031 goto decode_error;
8032 insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
8033 if (insn_len == (bfd_size_type) XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8034 goto decode_error;
8035
8036 if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
8037 {
8038 offset += insn_len;
8039 continue;
8040 }
8041
8042 xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
8043 opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
8044 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8045 goto decode_error;
8046
8047 if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_DENSITY) == 0
8048 && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
8049 && can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0)
8050 {
8051 /* Add an instruction narrow action. */
8052 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8053 ta_narrow_insn, offset, 0, false);
8054 }
8055 else if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
8056 && can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0
8057 && ! prev_instr_is_a_loop (ebb->contents,
8058 ebb->content_length, offset))
8059 {
8060 /* Add an instruction widen action. */
8061 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8062 ta_widen_insn, offset, 0, false);
8063 }
8064 else if (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) == 1)
8065 {
8066 /* Check for branch targets. */
8067 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN, 0,
8068 ta_none, offset, 0, true);
8069 }
8070
8071 offset += insn_len;
8072 }
8073 }
8074
8075 if (ebb->ends_unreachable)
8076 {
8077 ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8078 ta_fill, ebb->end_offset, 0, true);
8079 }
8080
8081 return true;
8082
8083 decode_error:
8084 _bfd_error_handler
8085 /* xgettext:c-format */
8086 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): could not decode instruction; "
8087 "possible configuration mismatch"),
8088 ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, (uint64_t) offset);
8089 return false;
8090 }
8091
8092
8093 /* After all of the information has collected about the
8094 transformations possible in an EBB, compute the appropriate actions
8095 here in compute_ebb_actions. We still must check later to make
8096 sure that the actions do not break any relocations. The algorithm
8097 used here is pretty greedy. Basically, it removes as many no-ops
8098 as possible so that the end of the EBB has the same alignment
8099 characteristics as the original. First, it uses narrowing, then
8100 fill space at the end of the EBB, and finally widenings. If that
8101 does not work, it tries again with one fewer no-op removed. The
8102 optimization will only be performed if all of the branch targets
8103 that were aligned before transformation are also aligned after the
8104 transformation.
8105
8106 When the size_opt flag is set, ignore the branch target alignments,
8107 narrow all wide instructions, and remove all no-ops unless the end
8108 of the EBB prevents it. */
8109
8110 bool
8111 compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
8112 {
8113 unsigned i = 0;
8114 unsigned j;
8115 int removed_bytes = 0;
8116 ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
8117 unsigned seg_idx_start = 0;
8118 unsigned seg_idx_end = 0;
8119
8120 /* We perform this like the assembler relaxation algorithm: Start by
8121 assuming all instructions are narrow and all no-ops removed; then
8122 walk through.... */
8123
8124 /* For each segment of this that has a solid constraint, check to
8125 see if there are any combinations that will keep the constraint.
8126 If so, use it. */
8127 for (seg_idx_end = 0; seg_idx_end < ebb_table->action_count; seg_idx_end++)
8128 {
8129 bool requires_text_end_align = false;
8130 unsigned longcall_count = 0;
8131 unsigned longcall_convert_count = 0;
8132 unsigned narrowable_count = 0;
8133 unsigned narrowable_convert_count = 0;
8134 unsigned widenable_count = 0;
8135 unsigned widenable_convert_count = 0;
8136
8137 proposed_action *action = NULL;
8138 int align = (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power);
8139
8140 seg_idx_start = seg_idx_end;
8141
8142 for (i = seg_idx_start; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
8143 {
8144 action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8145 if (action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
8146 longcall_count++;
8147 if (action->action == ta_narrow_insn)
8148 narrowable_count++;
8149 if (action->action == ta_widen_insn)
8150 widenable_count++;
8151 if (action->action == ta_fill)
8152 break;
8153 if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
8154 break;
8155 if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN
8156 && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
8157 break;
8158 }
8159 seg_idx_end = i;
8160
8161 if (seg_idx_end == ebb_table->action_count && !ebb->ends_unreachable)
8162 requires_text_end_align = true;
8163
8164 if (elf32xtensa_size_opt && !requires_text_end_align
8165 && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN
8166 && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
8167 {
8168 longcall_convert_count = longcall_count;
8169 narrowable_convert_count = narrowable_count;
8170 widenable_convert_count = 0;
8171 }
8172 else
8173 {
8174 /* There is a constraint. Convert the max number of longcalls. */
8175 narrowable_convert_count = 0;
8176 longcall_convert_count = 0;
8177 widenable_convert_count = 0;
8178
8179 for (j = 0; j < longcall_count; j++)
8180 {
8181 int removed = (longcall_count - j) * 3 & (align - 1);
8182 unsigned desire_narrow = (align - removed) & (align - 1);
8183 unsigned desire_widen = removed;
8184 if (desire_narrow <= narrowable_count)
8185 {
8186 narrowable_convert_count = desire_narrow;
8187 narrowable_convert_count +=
8188 (align * ((narrowable_count - narrowable_convert_count)
8189 / align));
8190 longcall_convert_count = (longcall_count - j);
8191 widenable_convert_count = 0;
8192 break;
8193 }
8194 if (desire_widen <= widenable_count && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
8195 {
8196 narrowable_convert_count = 0;
8197 longcall_convert_count = longcall_count - j;
8198 widenable_convert_count = desire_widen;
8199 break;
8200 }
8201 }
8202 }
8203
8204 /* Now the number of conversions are saved. Do them. */
8205 for (i = seg_idx_start; i < seg_idx_end; i++)
8206 {
8207 action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8208 switch (action->action)
8209 {
8210 case ta_convert_longcall:
8211 if (longcall_convert_count != 0)
8212 {
8213 action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
8214 action->do_action = true;
8215 action->removed_bytes += 3;
8216 longcall_convert_count--;
8217 }
8218 break;
8219 case ta_narrow_insn:
8220 if (narrowable_convert_count != 0)
8221 {
8222 action->do_action = true;
8223 action->removed_bytes += 1;
8224 narrowable_convert_count--;
8225 }
8226 break;
8227 case ta_widen_insn:
8228 if (widenable_convert_count != 0)
8229 {
8230 action->do_action = true;
8231 action->removed_bytes -= 1;
8232 widenable_convert_count--;
8233 }
8234 break;
8235 default:
8236 break;
8237 }
8238 }
8239 }
8240
8241 /* Now we move on to some local opts. Try to remove each of the
8242 remaining longcalls. */
8243
8244 if (ebb_table->ebb.ends_section || ebb_table->ebb.ends_unreachable)
8245 {
8246 removed_bytes = 0;
8247 for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
8248 {
8249 int old_removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
8250 proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8251
8252 if (action->do_action && action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
8253 {
8254 bool bad_alignment = false;
8255 removed_bytes += 3;
8256 for (j = i + 1; j < ebb_table->action_count; j++)
8257 {
8258 proposed_action *new_action = &ebb_table->actions[j];
8259 bfd_vma offset = new_action->offset;
8260 if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
8261 {
8262 if (!check_branch_target_aligned
8263 (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
8264 ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
8265 offset, offset - removed_bytes))
8266 {
8267 bad_alignment = true;
8268 break;
8269 }
8270 }
8271 if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
8272 {
8273 if (!check_loop_aligned (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
8274 ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
8275 offset,
8276 offset - removed_bytes))
8277 {
8278 bad_alignment = true;
8279 break;
8280 }
8281 }
8282 if (new_action->action == ta_narrow_insn
8283 && !new_action->do_action
8284 && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
8285 {
8286 /* Narrow an instruction and we are done. */
8287 new_action->do_action = true;
8288 new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
8289 bad_alignment = false;
8290 break;
8291 }
8292 if (new_action->action == ta_widen_insn
8293 && new_action->do_action
8294 && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
8295 {
8296 /* Narrow an instruction and we are done. */
8297 new_action->do_action = false;
8298 new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
8299 bad_alignment = false;
8300 break;
8301 }
8302 if (new_action->do_action)
8303 removed_bytes += new_action->removed_bytes;
8304 }
8305 if (!bad_alignment)
8306 {
8307 action->removed_bytes += 3;
8308 action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
8309 action->do_action = true;
8310 }
8311 }
8312 removed_bytes = old_removed_bytes;
8313 if (action->do_action)
8314 removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
8315 }
8316 }
8317
8318 removed_bytes = 0;
8319 for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; ++i)
8320 {
8321 proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8322 if (action->do_action)
8323 removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
8324 }
8325
8326 if ((removed_bytes % (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power)) != 0
8327 && ebb->ends_unreachable)
8328 {
8329 proposed_action *action;
8330 int br;
8331 int extra_space;
8332
8333 BFD_ASSERT (ebb_table->action_count != 0);
8334 action = &ebb_table->actions[ebb_table->action_count - 1];
8335 BFD_ASSERT (action->action == ta_fill);
8336 BFD_ASSERT (ebb->ends_unreachable->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE);
8337
8338 extra_space = xtensa_compute_fill_extra_space (ebb->ends_unreachable);
8339 br = action->removed_bytes + removed_bytes + extra_space;
8340 br = br & ((1 << ebb->sec->alignment_power ) - 1);
8341
8342 action->removed_bytes = extra_space - br;
8343 }
8344 return true;
8345 }
8346
8347
8348 /* The xlate_map is a sorted array of address mappings designed to
8349 answer the offset_with_removed_text() query with a binary search instead
8350 of a linear search through the section's action_list. */
8351
8352 typedef struct xlate_map_entry xlate_map_entry_t;
8353 typedef struct xlate_map xlate_map_t;
8354
8355 struct xlate_map_entry
8356 {
8357 bfd_vma orig_address;
8358 bfd_vma new_address;
8359 unsigned size;
8360 };
8361
8362 struct xlate_map
8363 {
8364 unsigned entry_count;
8365 xlate_map_entry_t *entry;
8366 };
8367
8368
8369 static int
8370 xlate_compare (const void *a_v, const void *b_v)
8371 {
8372 const xlate_map_entry_t *a = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) a_v;
8373 const xlate_map_entry_t *b = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) b_v;
8374 if (a->orig_address < b->orig_address)
8375 return -1;
8376 if (a->orig_address > (b->orig_address + b->size - 1))
8377 return 1;
8378 return 0;
8379 }
8380
8381
8382 static bfd_vma
8383 xlate_offset_with_removed_text (const xlate_map_t *map,
8384 text_action_list *action_list,
8385 bfd_vma offset)
8386 {
8387 void *r;
8388 xlate_map_entry_t *e;
8389 struct xlate_map_entry se;
8390
8391 if (map == NULL)
8392 return offset_with_removed_text (action_list, offset);
8393
8394 if (map->entry_count == 0)
8395 return offset;
8396
8397 se.orig_address = offset;
8398 r = bsearch (&se, map->entry, map->entry_count,
8399 sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t), &xlate_compare);
8400 e = (xlate_map_entry_t *) r;
8401
8402 /* There could be a jump past the end of the section,
8403 allow it using the last xlate map entry to translate its address. */
8404 if (e == NULL)
8405 {
8406 e = map->entry + map->entry_count - 1;
8407 if (xlate_compare (&se, e) <= 0)
8408 e = NULL;
8409 }
8410 BFD_ASSERT (e != NULL);
8411 if (e == NULL)
8412 return offset;
8413 return e->new_address - e->orig_address + offset;
8414 }
8415
8416 typedef struct xlate_map_context_struct xlate_map_context;
8417 struct xlate_map_context_struct
8418 {
8419 xlate_map_t *map;
8420 xlate_map_entry_t *current_entry;
8421 int removed;
8422 };
8423
8424 static int
8425 xlate_map_fn (splay_tree_node node, void *p)
8426 {
8427 text_action *r = (text_action *)node->value;
8428 xlate_map_context *ctx = p;
8429 unsigned orig_size = 0;
8430
8431 switch (r->action)
8432 {
8433 case ta_none:
8434 case ta_remove_insn:
8435 case ta_convert_longcall:
8436 case ta_remove_literal:
8437 case ta_add_literal:
8438 break;
8439 case ta_remove_longcall:
8440 orig_size = 6;
8441 break;
8442 case ta_narrow_insn:
8443 orig_size = 3;
8444 break;
8445 case ta_widen_insn:
8446 orig_size = 2;
8447 break;
8448 case ta_fill:
8449 break;
8450 }
8451 ctx->current_entry->size =
8452 r->offset + orig_size - ctx->current_entry->orig_address;
8453 if (ctx->current_entry->size != 0)
8454 {
8455 ctx->current_entry++;
8456 ctx->map->entry_count++;
8457 }
8458 ctx->current_entry->orig_address = r->offset + orig_size;
8459 ctx->removed += r->removed_bytes;
8460 ctx->current_entry->new_address = r->offset + orig_size - ctx->removed;
8461 ctx->current_entry->size = 0;
8462 return 0;
8463 }
8464
8465 /* Build a binary searchable offset translation map from a section's
8466 action list. */
8467
8468 static xlate_map_t *
8469 build_xlate_map (asection *sec, xtensa_relax_info *relax_info)
8470 {
8471 text_action_list *action_list = &relax_info->action_list;
8472 unsigned num_actions = 0;
8473 xlate_map_context ctx;
8474
8475 ctx.map = (xlate_map_t *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_t));
8476
8477 if (ctx.map == NULL)
8478 return NULL;
8479
8480 num_actions = action_list_count (action_list);
8481 ctx.map->entry = (xlate_map_entry_t *)
8482 bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t) * (num_actions + 1));
8483 if (ctx.map->entry == NULL)
8484 {
8485 free (ctx.map);
8486 return NULL;
8487 }
8488 ctx.map->entry_count = 0;
8489
8490 ctx.removed = 0;
8491 ctx.current_entry = &ctx.map->entry[0];
8492
8493 ctx.current_entry->orig_address = 0;
8494 ctx.current_entry->new_address = 0;
8495 ctx.current_entry->size = 0;
8496
8497 splay_tree_foreach (action_list->tree, xlate_map_fn, &ctx);
8498
8499 ctx.current_entry->size = (bfd_get_section_limit (sec->owner, sec)
8500 - ctx.current_entry->orig_address);
8501 if (ctx.current_entry->size != 0)
8502 ctx.map->entry_count++;
8503
8504 return ctx.map;
8505 }
8506
8507
8508 /* Free an offset translation map. */
8509
8510 static void
8511 free_xlate_map (xlate_map_t *map)
8512 {
8513 if (map)
8514 {
8515 free (map->entry);
8516 free (map);
8517 }
8518 }
8519
8520
8521 /* Use check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit to make sure that all of the
8522 relocations in a section will fit if a proposed set of actions
8523 are performed. */
8524
8525 static bool
8526 check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (bfd *abfd,
8527 asection *sec,
8528 bfd_byte *contents,
8529 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8530 reloc_range_list *relevant_relocs,
8531 const ebb_constraint *constraint,
8532 const xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes)
8533 {
8534 unsigned i, j;
8535 unsigned n = sec->reloc_count;
8536 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8537 xlate_map_t *xmap = NULL;
8538 bool ok = true;
8539 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8540 reloc_range_list_entry *entry = NULL;
8541
8542 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8543
8544 if (relax_info && sec->reloc_count > 100)
8545 {
8546 xmap = build_xlate_map (sec, relax_info);
8547 /* NULL indicates out of memory, but the slow version
8548 can still be used. */
8549 }
8550
8551 if (relevant_relocs && constraint->action_count)
8552 {
8553 if (!relevant_relocs->ok)
8554 {
8555 ok = false;
8556 n = 0;
8557 }
8558 else
8559 {
8560 bfd_vma min_offset, max_offset;
8561 min_offset = max_offset = constraint->actions[0].offset;
8562
8563 for (i = 1; i < constraint->action_count; ++i)
8564 {
8565 proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[i];
8566 bfd_vma offset = action->offset;
8567
8568 if (offset < min_offset)
8569 min_offset = offset;
8570 if (offset > max_offset)
8571 max_offset = offset;
8572 }
8573 reloc_range_list_update_range (relevant_relocs, min_offset,
8574 max_offset);
8575 n = relevant_relocs->n_list;
8576 entry = &relevant_relocs->list_root;
8577 }
8578 }
8579 else
8580 {
8581 relevant_relocs = NULL;
8582 }
8583
8584 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
8585 {
8586 r_reloc r_rel;
8587 bfd_vma orig_self_offset, orig_target_offset;
8588 bfd_vma self_offset, target_offset;
8589 int r_type;
8590 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8591 int self_removed_bytes, target_removed_bytes;
8592
8593 if (relevant_relocs)
8594 {
8595 entry = entry->next;
8596 irel = entry->irel;
8597 }
8598 else
8599 {
8600 irel = internal_relocs + i;
8601 }
8602 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8603
8604 howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
8605 /* We maintain the required invariant: PC-relative relocations
8606 that fit before linking must fit after linking. Thus we only
8607 need to deal with relocations to the same section that are
8608 PC-relative. */
8609 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY
8610 || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL
8611 || !howto->pc_relative)
8612 continue;
8613
8614 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
8615 bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
8616
8617 if (r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel) != sec)
8618 continue;
8619
8620 orig_self_offset = irel->r_offset;
8621 orig_target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
8622
8623 self_offset = orig_self_offset;
8624 target_offset = orig_target_offset;
8625
8626 if (relax_info)
8627 {
8628 self_offset =
8629 xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
8630 orig_self_offset);
8631 target_offset =
8632 xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
8633 orig_target_offset);
8634 }
8635
8636 self_removed_bytes = 0;
8637 target_removed_bytes = 0;
8638
8639 for (j = 0; j < constraint->action_count; ++j)
8640 {
8641 proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[j];
8642 bfd_vma offset = action->offset;
8643 int removed_bytes = action->removed_bytes;
8644 if (offset < orig_self_offset
8645 || (offset == orig_self_offset && action->action == ta_fill
8646 && action->removed_bytes < 0))
8647 self_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
8648 if (offset < orig_target_offset
8649 || (offset == orig_target_offset && action->action == ta_fill
8650 && action->removed_bytes < 0))
8651 target_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
8652 }
8653 self_offset -= self_removed_bytes;
8654 target_offset -= target_removed_bytes;
8655
8656 /* Try to encode it. Get the operand and check. */
8657 if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
8658 {
8659 /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
8660 and only PC-relative relocs matter here. */
8661 }
8662 else
8663 {
8664 xtensa_opcode opcode;
8665 int opnum;
8666
8667 if (relevant_relocs)
8668 {
8669 opcode = entry->opcode;
8670 opnum = entry->opnum;
8671 }
8672 else
8673 {
8674 if (reloc_opcodes)
8675 opcode = reloc_opcodes[relevant_relocs ?
8676 (unsigned)(entry - relevant_relocs->reloc) : i];
8677 else
8678 opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
8679 if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8680 {
8681 ok = false;
8682 break;
8683 }
8684
8685 opnum = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
8686 if (opnum == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8687 {
8688 ok = false;
8689 break;
8690 }
8691 }
8692
8693 if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (opcode, opnum, self_offset, target_offset))
8694 {
8695 ok = false;
8696 break;
8697 }
8698 }
8699 }
8700
8701 free_xlate_map (xmap);
8702
8703 return ok;
8704 }
8705
8706
8707 static bool
8708 check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *constraint)
8709 {
8710 int removed = 0;
8711 unsigned i;
8712
8713 for (i = 0; i < constraint->action_count; i++)
8714 {
8715 const proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[i];
8716 if (action->do_action)
8717 removed += action->removed_bytes;
8718 }
8719 if (removed < 0)
8720 return false;
8721
8722 return true;
8723 }
8724
8725
8726 void
8727 text_action_add_proposed (text_action_list *l,
8728 const ebb_constraint *ebb_table,
8729 asection *sec)
8730 {
8731 unsigned i;
8732
8733 for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
8734 {
8735 proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8736
8737 if (!action->do_action)
8738 continue;
8739 switch (action->action)
8740 {
8741 case ta_remove_insn:
8742 case ta_remove_longcall:
8743 case ta_convert_longcall:
8744 case ta_narrow_insn:
8745 case ta_widen_insn:
8746 case ta_fill:
8747 case ta_remove_literal:
8748 text_action_add (l, action->action, sec, action->offset,
8749 action->removed_bytes);
8750 break;
8751 case ta_none:
8752 break;
8753 default:
8754 BFD_ASSERT (0);
8755 break;
8756 }
8757 }
8758 }
8759
8760
8761 int
8762 xtensa_compute_fill_extra_space (property_table_entry *entry)
8763 {
8764 int fill_extra_space;
8765
8766 if (!entry)
8767 return 0;
8768
8769 if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
8770 return 0;
8771
8772 fill_extra_space = entry->size;
8773 if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0)
8774 {
8775 /* Fill bytes for alignment:
8776 (2**n)-1 - (addr + (2**n)-1) & (2**n -1) */
8777 int pow = GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (entry->flags);
8778 int nsm = (1 << pow) - 1;
8779 bfd_vma addr = entry->address + entry->size;
8780 bfd_vma align_fill = nsm - ((addr + nsm) & nsm);
8781 fill_extra_space += align_fill;
8782 }
8783 return fill_extra_space;
8784 }
8785
8786 \f
8787 /* First relaxation pass. */
8788
8789 /* If the section contains relaxable literals, check each literal to
8790 see if it has the same value as another literal that has already
8791 been seen, either in the current section or a previous one. If so,
8792 add an entry to the per-section list of removed literals. The
8793 actual changes are deferred until the next pass. */
8794
8795 static bool
8796 compute_removed_literals (bfd *abfd,
8797 asection *sec,
8798 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8799 value_map_hash_table *values)
8800 {
8801 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8802 bfd_byte *contents;
8803 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8804 source_reloc *src_relocs, *rel;
8805 bool ok = true;
8806 property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
8807 int ptblsize;
8808 int i, prev_i;
8809 bool last_loc_is_prev = false;
8810 bfd_vma last_target_offset = 0;
8811 section_cache_t target_sec_cache;
8812 bfd_size_type sec_size;
8813
8814 init_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8815
8816 /* Do nothing if it is not a relaxable literal section. */
8817 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8818 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
8819 if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section)
8820 return ok;
8821
8822 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
8823 link_info->keep_memory);
8824
8825 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8826 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
8827 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
8828 {
8829 ok = false;
8830 goto error_return;
8831 }
8832
8833 /* Sort the source_relocs by target offset. */
8834 src_relocs = relax_info->src_relocs;
8835 qsort (src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8836 sizeof (source_reloc), source_reloc_compare);
8837 qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
8838 internal_reloc_compare);
8839
8840 ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
8841 XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, false);
8842 if (ptblsize < 0)
8843 {
8844 ok = false;
8845 goto error_return;
8846 }
8847
8848 prev_i = -1;
8849 for (i = 0; i < relax_info->src_count; i++)
8850 {
8851 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = NULL;
8852
8853 rel = &src_relocs[i];
8854 if (get_l32r_opcode () != rel->opcode)
8855 continue;
8856 irel = get_irel_at_offset (sec, internal_relocs,
8857 rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8858
8859 /* If the relocation on this is not a simple R_XTENSA_32 or
8860 R_XTENSA_PLT then do not consider it. This may happen when
8861 the difference of two symbols is used in a literal. */
8862 if (irel && (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_32
8863 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_PLT))
8864 continue;
8865
8866 /* If the target_offset for this relocation is the same as the
8867 previous relocation, then we've already considered whether the
8868 literal can be coalesced. Skip to the next one.... */
8869 if (i != 0 && prev_i != -1
8870 && src_relocs[i-1].r_rel.target_offset == rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8871 continue;
8872 prev_i = i;
8873
8874 if (last_loc_is_prev &&
8875 last_target_offset + 4 != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8876 last_loc_is_prev = false;
8877
8878 /* Check if the relocation was from an L32R that is being removed
8879 because a CALLX was converted to a direct CALL, and check if
8880 there are no other relocations to the literal. */
8881 if (is_removable_literal (rel, i, src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8882 sec, prop_table, ptblsize))
8883 {
8884 if (!remove_dead_literal (abfd, sec, link_info, internal_relocs,
8885 irel, rel, prop_table, ptblsize))
8886 {
8887 ok = false;
8888 goto error_return;
8889 }
8890 last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8891 continue;
8892 }
8893
8894 if (!identify_literal_placement (abfd, sec, contents, link_info,
8895 values,
8896 &last_loc_is_prev, irel,
8897 relax_info->src_count - i, rel,
8898 prop_table, ptblsize,
8899 &target_sec_cache, rel->is_abs_literal))
8900 {
8901 ok = false;
8902 goto error_return;
8903 }
8904 last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8905 }
8906
8907 #if DEBUG
8908 print_removed_literals (stderr, &relax_info->removed_list);
8909 print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
8910 #endif /* DEBUG */
8911
8912 error_return:
8913 free (prop_table);
8914 free_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8915
8916 release_contents (sec, contents);
8917 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8918 return ok;
8919 }
8920
8921
8922 static Elf_Internal_Rela *
8923 get_irel_at_offset (asection *sec,
8924 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8925 bfd_vma offset)
8926 {
8927 unsigned i;
8928 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8929 unsigned r_type;
8930 Elf_Internal_Rela key;
8931
8932 if (!internal_relocs)
8933 return NULL;
8934
8935 key.r_offset = offset;
8936 irel = bsearch (&key, internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count,
8937 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_matches);
8938 if (!irel)
8939 return NULL;
8940
8941 /* bsearch does not guarantee which will be returned if there are
8942 multiple matches. We need the first that is not an alignment. */
8943 i = irel - internal_relocs;
8944 while (i > 0)
8945 {
8946 if (internal_relocs[i-1].r_offset != offset)
8947 break;
8948 i--;
8949 }
8950 for ( ; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
8951 {
8952 irel = &internal_relocs[i];
8953 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8954 if (irel->r_offset == offset && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE)
8955 return irel;
8956 }
8957
8958 return NULL;
8959 }
8960
8961
8962 bool
8963 is_removable_literal (const source_reloc *rel,
8964 int i,
8965 const source_reloc *src_relocs,
8966 int src_count,
8967 asection *sec,
8968 property_table_entry *prop_table,
8969 int ptblsize)
8970 {
8971 const source_reloc *curr_rel;
8972 property_table_entry *entry;
8973
8974 if (!rel->is_null)
8975 return false;
8976
8977 entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8978 sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8979 if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
8980 return false;
8981
8982 for (++i; i < src_count; ++i)
8983 {
8984 curr_rel = &src_relocs[i];
8985 /* If all others have the same target offset.... */
8986 if (curr_rel->r_rel.target_offset != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8987 return true;
8988
8989 if (!curr_rel->is_null
8990 && !xtensa_is_property_section (curr_rel->source_sec)
8991 && !(curr_rel->source_sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
8992 return false;
8993 }
8994 return true;
8995 }
8996
8997
8998 bool
8999 remove_dead_literal (bfd *abfd,
9000 asection *sec,
9001 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9002 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
9003 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
9004 source_reloc *rel,
9005 property_table_entry *prop_table,
9006 int ptblsize)
9007 {
9008 property_table_entry *entry;
9009 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9010
9011 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9012 if (!relax_info)
9013 return false;
9014
9015 entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
9016 sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
9017
9018 /* Mark the unused literal so that it will be removed. */
9019 add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, NULL);
9020
9021 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9022 ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
9023
9024 /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill. */
9025 if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
9026 {
9027 int fill_extra_space;
9028 bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
9029 text_action *fa;
9030 property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
9031 int removed_diff;
9032
9033 if (entry)
9034 entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
9035 else
9036 entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
9037
9038 /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
9039 do not add fill. */
9040 the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
9041 entry_sec_offset);
9042 fill_extra_space = xtensa_compute_fill_extra_space (the_add_entry);
9043
9044 fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
9045 removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
9046 -4, fill_extra_space);
9047 if (fa)
9048 adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
9049 else
9050 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9051 ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
9052 }
9053
9054 /* Zero out the relocation on this literal location. */
9055 if (irel)
9056 {
9057 if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9058 shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
9059
9060 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
9061 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9062 }
9063
9064 /* Do not modify "last_loc_is_prev". */
9065 return true;
9066 }
9067
9068
9069 bool
9070 identify_literal_placement (bfd *abfd,
9071 asection *sec,
9072 bfd_byte *contents,
9073 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9074 value_map_hash_table *values,
9075 bool *last_loc_is_prev_p,
9076 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
9077 int remaining_src_rels,
9078 source_reloc *rel,
9079 property_table_entry *prop_table,
9080 int ptblsize,
9081 section_cache_t *target_sec_cache,
9082 bool is_abs_literal)
9083 {
9084 literal_value val;
9085 value_map *val_map;
9086 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9087 bool literal_placed = false;
9088 r_reloc r_rel;
9089 unsigned long value;
9090 bool final_static_link;
9091 bfd_size_type sec_size;
9092
9093 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9094 if (!relax_info)
9095 return false;
9096
9097 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
9098
9099 final_static_link =
9100 (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
9101 && !elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created);
9102
9103 /* The placement algorithm first checks to see if the literal is
9104 already in the value map. If so and the value map is reachable
9105 from all uses, then the literal is moved to that location. If
9106 not, then we identify the last location where a fresh literal was
9107 placed. If the literal can be safely moved there, then we do so.
9108 If not, then we assume that the literal is not to move and leave
9109 the literal where it is, marking it as the last literal
9110 location. */
9111
9112 /* Find the literal value. */
9113 value = 0;
9114 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
9115 if (!irel)
9116 {
9117 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_rel.target_offset < sec_size);
9118 value = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
9119 }
9120 init_literal_value (&val, &r_rel, value, is_abs_literal);
9121
9122 /* Check if we've seen another literal with the same value that
9123 is in the same output section. */
9124 val_map = value_map_get_cached_value (values, &val, final_static_link);
9125
9126 if (val_map
9127 && (r_reloc_get_section (&val_map->loc)->output_section
9128 == sec->output_section)
9129 && relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &val_map->loc)
9130 && coalesce_shared_literal (sec, rel, prop_table, ptblsize, val_map))
9131 {
9132 /* No change to last_loc_is_prev. */
9133 literal_placed = true;
9134 }
9135
9136 /* For relocatable links, do not try to move literals. To do it
9137 correctly might increase the number of relocations in an input
9138 section making the default relocatable linking fail. */
9139 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && !literal_placed
9140 && values->has_last_loc && !(*last_loc_is_prev_p))
9141 {
9142 asection *target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&values->last_loc);
9143 if (target_sec && target_sec->output_section == sec->output_section)
9144 {
9145 /* Increment the virtual offset. */
9146 r_reloc try_loc = values->last_loc;
9147 try_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
9148
9149 /* There is a last loc that was in the same output section. */
9150 if (relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &try_loc)
9151 && move_shared_literal (sec, link_info, rel,
9152 prop_table, ptblsize,
9153 &try_loc, &val, target_sec_cache))
9154 {
9155 values->last_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
9156 literal_placed = true;
9157 if (!val_map)
9158 val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &try_loc,
9159 final_static_link);
9160 else
9161 val_map->loc = try_loc;
9162 }
9163 }
9164 }
9165
9166 if (!literal_placed)
9167 {
9168 /* Nothing worked, leave the literal alone but update the last loc. */
9169 values->has_last_loc = true;
9170 values->last_loc = rel->r_rel;
9171 if (!val_map)
9172 val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &rel->r_rel, final_static_link);
9173 else
9174 val_map->loc = rel->r_rel;
9175 *last_loc_is_prev_p = true;
9176 }
9177
9178 return true;
9179 }
9180
9181
9182 /* Check if the original relocations (presumably on L32R instructions)
9183 identified by reloc[0..N] can be changed to reference the literal
9184 identified by r_rel. If r_rel is out of range for any of the
9185 original relocations, then we don't want to coalesce the original
9186 literal with the one at r_rel. We only check reloc[0..N], where the
9187 offsets are all the same as for reloc[0] (i.e., they're all
9188 referencing the same literal) and where N is also bounded by the
9189 number of remaining entries in the "reloc" array. The "reloc" array
9190 is sorted by target offset so we know all the entries for the same
9191 literal will be contiguous. */
9192
9193 static bool
9194 relocations_reach (source_reloc *reloc,
9195 int remaining_relocs,
9196 const r_reloc *r_rel)
9197 {
9198 bfd_vma from_offset, source_address, dest_address;
9199 asection *sec;
9200 int i;
9201
9202 if (!r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
9203 return false;
9204
9205 sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
9206 from_offset = reloc[0].r_rel.target_offset;
9207
9208 for (i = 0; i < remaining_relocs; i++)
9209 {
9210 if (reloc[i].r_rel.target_offset != from_offset)
9211 break;
9212
9213 /* Ignore relocations that have been removed. */
9214 if (reloc[i].is_null)
9215 continue;
9216
9217 /* The original and new output section for these must be the same
9218 in order to coalesce. */
9219 if (r_reloc_get_section (&reloc[i].r_rel)->output_section
9220 != sec->output_section)
9221 return false;
9222
9223 /* Absolute literals in the same output section can always be
9224 combined. */
9225 if (reloc[i].is_abs_literal)
9226 continue;
9227
9228 /* A literal with no PC-relative relocations can be moved anywhere. */
9229 if (reloc[i].opnd != -1)
9230 {
9231 /* Otherwise, check to see that it fits. */
9232 source_address = (reloc[i].source_sec->output_section->vma
9233 + reloc[i].source_sec->output_offset
9234 + reloc[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset);
9235 dest_address = (sec->output_section->vma
9236 + sec->output_offset
9237 + r_rel->target_offset);
9238
9239 if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (reloc[i].opcode, reloc[i].opnd,
9240 source_address, dest_address))
9241 return false;
9242 }
9243 }
9244
9245 return true;
9246 }
9247
9248
9249 /* Move a literal to another literal location because it is
9250 the same as the other literal value. */
9251
9252 static bool
9253 coalesce_shared_literal (asection *sec,
9254 source_reloc *rel,
9255 property_table_entry *prop_table,
9256 int ptblsize,
9257 value_map *val_map)
9258 {
9259 property_table_entry *entry;
9260 text_action *fa;
9261 property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
9262 int removed_diff;
9263 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9264
9265 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9266 if (!relax_info)
9267 return false;
9268
9269 entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
9270 (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
9271 if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
9272 return true;
9273
9274 /* Mark that the literal will be coalesced. */
9275 add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, &val_map->loc);
9276
9277 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9278 ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
9279
9280 /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill. */
9281 if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
9282 {
9283 int fill_extra_space;
9284 bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
9285
9286 if (entry)
9287 entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
9288 else
9289 entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
9290
9291 /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
9292 do not add fill. */
9293 fill_extra_space = 0;
9294 the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
9295 entry_sec_offset);
9296 if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
9297 fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
9298
9299 fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
9300 removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
9301 -4, fill_extra_space);
9302 if (fa)
9303 adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
9304 else
9305 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9306 ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
9307 }
9308
9309 return true;
9310 }
9311
9312
9313 /* Move a literal to another location. This may actually increase the
9314 total amount of space used because of alignments so we need to do
9315 this carefully. Also, it may make a branch go out of range. */
9316
9317 static bool
9318 move_shared_literal (asection *sec,
9319 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9320 source_reloc *rel,
9321 property_table_entry *prop_table,
9322 int ptblsize,
9323 const r_reloc *target_loc,
9324 const literal_value *lit_value,
9325 section_cache_t *target_sec_cache)
9326 {
9327 property_table_entry *the_add_entry, *src_entry, *target_entry = NULL;
9328 text_action *fa, *target_fa;
9329 int removed_diff;
9330 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info, *target_relax_info;
9331 asection *target_sec;
9332 ebb_t *ebb;
9333 ebb_constraint ebb_table;
9334 bool relocs_fit;
9335
9336 /* If this routine always returns FALSE, the literals that cannot be
9337 coalesced will not be moved. */
9338 if (elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement)
9339 return false;
9340
9341 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9342 if (!relax_info)
9343 return false;
9344
9345 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (target_loc);
9346 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
9347
9348 /* Literals to undefined sections may not be moved because they
9349 must report an error. */
9350 if (bfd_is_und_section (target_sec))
9351 return false;
9352
9353 src_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
9354 (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
9355
9356 if (!section_cache_section (target_sec_cache, target_sec, link_info))
9357 return false;
9358
9359 target_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
9360 (target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
9361 target_sec->vma + target_loc->target_offset);
9362
9363 if (!target_entry)
9364 return false;
9365
9366 /* Make sure that we have not broken any branches. */
9367 relocs_fit = false;
9368
9369 init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
9370 ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
9371 init_ebb (ebb, target_sec_cache->sec, target_sec_cache->contents,
9372 target_sec_cache->content_length,
9373 target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
9374 target_sec_cache->relocs, target_sec_cache->reloc_count);
9375
9376 /* Propose to add 4 bytes + worst-case alignment size increase to
9377 destination. */
9378 ebb_propose_action (&ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
9379 ta_fill, target_loc->target_offset,
9380 -4 - (1 << target_sec->alignment_power), true);
9381
9382 /* Check all of the PC-relative relocations to make sure they still fit. */
9383 relocs_fit = check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (target_sec->owner, target_sec,
9384 target_sec_cache->contents,
9385 target_sec_cache->relocs, NULL,
9386 &ebb_table, NULL);
9387
9388 if (!relocs_fit)
9389 return false;
9390
9391 text_action_add_literal (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9392 ta_add_literal, target_loc, lit_value, -4);
9393
9394 if (target_sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
9395 {
9396 /* May need to add or remove some fill to maintain alignment. */
9397 int fill_extra_space;
9398 bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
9399
9400 entry_sec_offset =
9401 target_entry->address - target_sec->vma + target_entry->size;
9402
9403 /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
9404 do not add fill. */
9405 fill_extra_space = 0;
9406 the_add_entry =
9407 elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (target_sec_cache->ptbl,
9408 target_sec_cache->pte_count,
9409 entry_sec_offset);
9410 if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
9411 fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
9412
9413 target_fa = find_fill_action (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9414 target_sec, entry_sec_offset);
9415 removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (target_fa, target_sec,
9416 entry_sec_offset, 4,
9417 fill_extra_space);
9418 if (target_fa)
9419 adjust_fill_action (target_fa, removed_diff);
9420 else
9421 text_action_add (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9422 ta_fill, target_sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
9423 }
9424
9425 /* Mark that the literal will be moved to the new location. */
9426 add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, target_loc);
9427
9428 /* Remove the literal. */
9429 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9430 ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
9431
9432 /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill. */
9433 if (sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
9434 {
9435 int fill_extra_space;
9436 bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
9437
9438 if (src_entry)
9439 entry_sec_offset = src_entry->address - sec->vma + src_entry->size;
9440 else
9441 entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset+4;
9442
9443 /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
9444 do not add fill. */
9445 fill_extra_space = 0;
9446 the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
9447 entry_sec_offset);
9448 if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
9449 fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
9450
9451 fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
9452 removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
9453 -4, fill_extra_space);
9454 if (fa)
9455 adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
9456 else
9457 text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
9458 ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
9459 }
9460
9461 return true;
9462 }
9463
9464 \f
9465 /* Second relaxation pass. */
9466
9467 static int
9468 action_remove_bytes_fn (splay_tree_node node, void *p)
9469 {
9470 bfd_size_type *final_size = p;
9471 text_action *action = (text_action *)node->value;
9472
9473 *final_size -= action->removed_bytes;
9474 return 0;
9475 }
9476
9477 /* Modify all of the relocations to point to the right spot, and if this
9478 is a relaxable section, delete the unwanted literals and fix the
9479 section size. */
9480
9481 bool
9482 relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
9483 {
9484 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
9485 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9486 bfd_byte *contents;
9487 bool ok = true;
9488 unsigned i;
9489 bool rv = false;
9490 bool virtual_action;
9491 bfd_size_type sec_size;
9492
9493 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
9494 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9495 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
9496
9497 /* First translate any of the fixes that have been added already. */
9498 translate_section_fixes (sec);
9499
9500 /* Handle property sections (e.g., literal tables) specially. */
9501 if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
9502 {
9503 BFD_ASSERT (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section);
9504 return relax_property_section (abfd, sec, link_info);
9505 }
9506
9507 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
9508 link_info->keep_memory);
9509 if (!internal_relocs && !action_list_count (&relax_info->action_list))
9510 return true;
9511
9512 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
9513 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
9514 {
9515 ok = false;
9516 goto error_return;
9517 }
9518
9519 if (internal_relocs)
9520 {
9521 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
9522 {
9523 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
9524 xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
9525 bfd_vma source_offset, old_source_offset;
9526 r_reloc r_rel;
9527 unsigned r_type;
9528 asection *target_sec;
9529
9530 /* Locally change the source address.
9531 Translate the target to the new target address.
9532 If it points to this section and has been removed,
9533 NULLify it.
9534 Write it back. */
9535
9536 irel = &internal_relocs[i];
9537 source_offset = irel->r_offset;
9538 old_source_offset = source_offset;
9539
9540 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
9541 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
9542 bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
9543
9544 /* If this section could have changed then we may need to
9545 change the relocation's offset. */
9546
9547 if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9548 || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9549 {
9550 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9551
9552 if (r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
9553 && find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
9554 irel->r_offset))
9555 {
9556 /* Remove this relocation. */
9557 if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9558 shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
9559 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
9560 irel->r_offset = offset_with_removed_text_map
9561 (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
9562 continue;
9563 }
9564
9565 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
9566 {
9567 text_action *action =
9568 find_insn_action (&relax_info->action_list,
9569 irel->r_offset);
9570 if (action && (action->action == ta_convert_longcall
9571 || action->action == ta_remove_longcall))
9572 {
9573 bfd_reloc_status_type retval;
9574 char *error_message = NULL;
9575
9576 retval = contract_asm_expansion (contents, sec_size,
9577 irel, &error_message);
9578 if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
9579 {
9580 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9581 (link_info, error_message, abfd, sec,
9582 irel->r_offset);
9583 goto error_return;
9584 }
9585 /* Update the action so that the code that moves
9586 the contents will do the right thing. */
9587 /* ta_remove_longcall and ta_remove_insn actions are
9588 grouped together in the tree as well as
9589 ta_convert_longcall and ta_none, so that changes below
9590 can be done w/o removing and reinserting action into
9591 the tree. */
9592
9593 if (action->action == ta_remove_longcall)
9594 action->action = ta_remove_insn;
9595 else
9596 action->action = ta_none;
9597 /* Refresh the info in the r_rel. */
9598 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
9599 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
9600 }
9601 }
9602
9603 source_offset = offset_with_removed_text_map
9604 (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
9605 irel->r_offset = source_offset;
9606 }
9607
9608 /* If the target section could have changed then
9609 we may need to change the relocation's target offset. */
9610
9611 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
9612
9613 /* For a reference to a discarded section from a DWARF section,
9614 i.e., where action_discarded is PRETEND, the symbol will
9615 eventually be modified to refer to the kept section (at least if
9616 the kept and discarded sections are the same size). Anticipate
9617 that here and adjust things accordingly. */
9618 if (! elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (sec)
9619 && elf_xtensa_action_discarded (sec) == PRETEND
9620 && sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS
9621 && target_sec != NULL
9622 && discarded_section (target_sec))
9623 {
9624 /* It would be natural to call _bfd_elf_check_kept_section
9625 here, but it's not exported from elflink.c. It's also a
9626 fairly expensive check. Adjusting the relocations to the
9627 discarded section is fairly harmless; it will only adjust
9628 some addends and difference values. If it turns out that
9629 _bfd_elf_check_kept_section fails later, it won't matter,
9630 so just compare the section names to find the right group
9631 member. */
9632 asection *kept = target_sec->kept_section;
9633 if (kept != NULL)
9634 {
9635 if ((kept->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
9636 {
9637 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (kept);
9638 asection *s = first;
9639
9640 kept = NULL;
9641 while (s != NULL)
9642 {
9643 if (strcmp (s->name, target_sec->name) == 0)
9644 {
9645 kept = s;
9646 break;
9647 }
9648 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
9649 if (s == first)
9650 break;
9651 }
9652 }
9653 }
9654 if (kept != NULL
9655 && ((target_sec->rawsize != 0
9656 ? target_sec->rawsize : target_sec->size)
9657 == (kept->rawsize != 0 ? kept->rawsize : kept->size)))
9658 target_sec = kept;
9659 }
9660
9661 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
9662 if (target_relax_info
9663 && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9664 || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
9665 {
9666 r_reloc new_reloc;
9667 target_sec = translate_reloc (&r_rel, &new_reloc, target_sec);
9668
9669 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF8
9670 || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF16
9671 || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF32
9672 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PDIFF8
9673 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PDIFF16
9674 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PDIFF32
9675 || r_type == R_XTENSA_NDIFF8
9676 || r_type == R_XTENSA_NDIFF16
9677 || r_type == R_XTENSA_NDIFF32)
9678 {
9679 bfd_signed_vma diff_value = 0;
9680 bfd_vma new_end_offset, diff_mask = 0;
9681
9682 if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) < old_source_offset)
9683 {
9684 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9685 (link_info, _("invalid relocation address"),
9686 abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
9687 goto error_return;
9688 }
9689
9690 switch (r_type)
9691 {
9692 case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
9693 diff_mask = 0x7f;
9694 diff_value =
9695 bfd_get_signed_8 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9696 break;
9697 case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
9698 diff_mask = 0x7fff;
9699 diff_value =
9700 bfd_get_signed_16 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9701 break;
9702 case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
9703 diff_mask = 0x7fffffff;
9704 diff_value =
9705 bfd_get_signed_32 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9706 break;
9707 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF8:
9708 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF8:
9709 diff_mask = 0xff;
9710 diff_value =
9711 bfd_get_8 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9712 break;
9713 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF16:
9714 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF16:
9715 diff_mask = 0xffff;
9716 diff_value =
9717 bfd_get_16 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9718 break;
9719 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF32:
9720 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF32:
9721 diff_mask = 0xffffffff;
9722 diff_value =
9723 bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9724 break;
9725 }
9726
9727 if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_NDIFF8
9728 && r_type <= R_XTENSA_NDIFF32
9729 && diff_value)
9730 diff_value |= ~diff_mask;
9731
9732 new_end_offset = offset_with_removed_text_map
9733 (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9734 r_rel.target_offset + diff_value);
9735 diff_value = new_end_offset - new_reloc.target_offset;
9736
9737 switch (r_type)
9738 {
9739 case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
9740 bfd_put_signed_8 (abfd, diff_value,
9741 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9742 break;
9743 case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
9744 bfd_put_signed_16 (abfd, diff_value,
9745 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9746 break;
9747 case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
9748 bfd_put_signed_32 (abfd, diff_value,
9749 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9750 break;
9751 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF8:
9752 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF8:
9753 bfd_put_8 (abfd, diff_value,
9754 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9755 break;
9756 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF16:
9757 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF16:
9758 bfd_put_16 (abfd, diff_value,
9759 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9760 break;
9761 case R_XTENSA_PDIFF32:
9762 case R_XTENSA_NDIFF32:
9763 bfd_put_32 (abfd, diff_value,
9764 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9765 break;
9766 }
9767
9768 /* Check for overflow. Sign bits must be all zeroes or
9769 all ones. When sign bits are all ones diff_value
9770 may not be zero. */
9771 if (((diff_value & ~diff_mask) != 0
9772 && (diff_value & ~diff_mask) != ~diff_mask)
9773 || (diff_value && (bfd_vma) diff_value == ~diff_mask))
9774 {
9775 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9776 (link_info, _("overflow after relaxation"),
9777 abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
9778 goto error_return;
9779 }
9780
9781 pin_contents (sec, contents);
9782 }
9783
9784 /* If the relocation still references a section in the same
9785 input file, modify the relocation directly instead of
9786 adding a "fix" record. */
9787 if (target_sec->owner == abfd)
9788 {
9789 unsigned r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (new_reloc.rela.r_info);
9790 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
9791 irel->r_addend = new_reloc.rela.r_addend;
9792 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9793 }
9794 else
9795 {
9796 bfd_vma addend_displacement;
9797 reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
9798
9799 addend_displacement =
9800 new_reloc.target_offset + new_reloc.virtual_offset;
9801 fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, source_offset, r_type,
9802 target_sec,
9803 addend_displacement, true);
9804 add_fix (sec, fix);
9805 }
9806 }
9807 }
9808 }
9809
9810 if ((relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9811 || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9812 && action_list_count (&relax_info->action_list))
9813 {
9814 /* Walk through the planned actions and build up a table
9815 of move, copy and fill records. Use the move, copy and
9816 fill records to perform the actions once. */
9817
9818 bfd_size_type final_size, copy_size, orig_insn_size;
9819 bfd_byte *scratch = NULL;
9820 bfd_byte *dup_contents = NULL;
9821 bfd_size_type orig_size = sec->size;
9822 bfd_vma orig_dot = 0;
9823 bfd_vma orig_dot_copied = 0; /* Byte copied already from
9824 orig dot in physical memory. */
9825 bfd_vma orig_dot_vo = 0; /* Virtual offset from orig_dot. */
9826 bfd_vma dup_dot = 0;
9827
9828 text_action *action;
9829
9830 final_size = sec->size;
9831
9832 splay_tree_foreach (relax_info->action_list.tree,
9833 action_remove_bytes_fn, &final_size);
9834 scratch = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9835 dup_contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9836
9837 /* The dot is the current fill location. */
9838 #if DEBUG
9839 print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
9840 #endif
9841
9842 for (action = action_first (&relax_info->action_list); action;
9843 action = action_next (&relax_info->action_list, action))
9844 {
9845 virtual_action = false;
9846 if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9847 {
9848 orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9849 orig_dot_copied = 0;
9850 orig_dot_vo = 0;
9851 /* Out of the virtual world. */
9852 }
9853
9854 if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9855 {
9856 copy_size = action->offset - orig_dot;
9857 memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9858 orig_dot += copy_size;
9859 dup_dot += copy_size;
9860 BFD_ASSERT (action->offset == orig_dot);
9861 }
9862 else if (action->offset < orig_dot)
9863 {
9864 if (action->action == ta_fill
9865 && action->offset - action->removed_bytes == orig_dot)
9866 {
9867 /* This is OK because the fill only effects the dup_dot. */
9868 }
9869 else if (action->action == ta_add_literal)
9870 {
9871 /* TBD. Might need to handle this. */
9872 }
9873 }
9874 if (action->offset == orig_dot)
9875 {
9876 if (action->virtual_offset > orig_dot_vo)
9877 {
9878 if (orig_dot_vo == 0)
9879 {
9880 /* Need to copy virtual_offset bytes. Probably four. */
9881 copy_size = action->virtual_offset - orig_dot_vo;
9882 memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot],
9883 &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9884 orig_dot_copied = copy_size;
9885 dup_dot += copy_size;
9886 }
9887 virtual_action = true;
9888 }
9889 else
9890 BFD_ASSERT (action->virtual_offset <= orig_dot_vo);
9891 }
9892 switch (action->action)
9893 {
9894 case ta_remove_literal:
9895 case ta_remove_insn:
9896 BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes >= 0);
9897 orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9898 break;
9899
9900 case ta_narrow_insn:
9901 orig_insn_size = 3;
9902 copy_size = 2;
9903 memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9904 BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 1);
9905 rv = narrow_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9906 BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9907 memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9908 orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9909 dup_dot += copy_size;
9910 break;
9911
9912 case ta_fill:
9913 if (action->removed_bytes >= 0)
9914 orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9915 else
9916 {
9917 /* Already zeroed in dup_contents. Just bump the
9918 counters. */
9919 dup_dot += (-action->removed_bytes);
9920 }
9921 break;
9922
9923 case ta_none:
9924 BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 0);
9925 break;
9926
9927 case ta_convert_longcall:
9928 case ta_remove_longcall:
9929 /* These will be removed or converted before we get here. */
9930 BFD_ASSERT (0);
9931 break;
9932
9933 case ta_widen_insn:
9934 orig_insn_size = 2;
9935 copy_size = 3;
9936 memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9937 BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -1);
9938 rv = widen_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9939 BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9940 memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9941 orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9942 dup_dot += copy_size;
9943 break;
9944
9945 case ta_add_literal:
9946 orig_insn_size = 0;
9947 copy_size = 4;
9948 BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -4);
9949 /* TBD -- place the literal value here and insert
9950 into the table. */
9951 memset (&dup_contents[dup_dot], 0, 4);
9952 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9953 pin_contents (sec, contents);
9954
9955 if (!move_literal (abfd, link_info, sec, dup_dot, dup_contents,
9956 relax_info, &internal_relocs, &action->value))
9957 goto error_return;
9958
9959 if (virtual_action)
9960 orig_dot_vo += copy_size;
9961
9962 orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9963 dup_dot += copy_size;
9964 break;
9965
9966 default:
9967 /* Not implemented yet. */
9968 BFD_ASSERT (0);
9969 break;
9970 }
9971
9972 BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot <= final_size);
9973 BFD_ASSERT (orig_dot <= orig_size);
9974 }
9975
9976 orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9977 orig_dot_copied = 0;
9978
9979 if (orig_dot != orig_size)
9980 {
9981 copy_size = orig_size - orig_dot;
9982 BFD_ASSERT (orig_size > orig_dot);
9983 BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot + copy_size == final_size);
9984 memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9985 orig_dot += copy_size;
9986 dup_dot += copy_size;
9987 }
9988 BFD_ASSERT (orig_size == orig_dot);
9989 BFD_ASSERT (final_size == dup_dot);
9990
9991 /* Move the dup_contents back. */
9992 if (final_size > orig_size)
9993 {
9994 /* Contents need to be reallocated. Swap the dup_contents into
9995 contents. */
9996 sec->contents = dup_contents;
9997 free (contents);
9998 contents = dup_contents;
9999 pin_contents (sec, contents);
10000 }
10001 else
10002 {
10003 BFD_ASSERT (final_size <= orig_size);
10004 memset (contents, 0, orig_size);
10005 memcpy (contents, dup_contents, final_size);
10006 free (dup_contents);
10007 }
10008 free (scratch);
10009 pin_contents (sec, contents);
10010
10011 if (sec->rawsize == 0)
10012 sec->rawsize = sec->size;
10013 sec->size = final_size;
10014 }
10015
10016 error_return:
10017 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10018 release_contents (sec, contents);
10019 return ok;
10020 }
10021
10022
10023 static bool
10024 translate_section_fixes (asection *sec)
10025 {
10026 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10027 reloc_bfd_fix *r;
10028
10029 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10030 if (!relax_info)
10031 return true;
10032
10033 for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
10034 if (!translate_reloc_bfd_fix (r))
10035 return false;
10036
10037 return true;
10038 }
10039
10040
10041 /* Translate a fix given the mapping in the relax info for the target
10042 section. If it has already been translated, no work is required. */
10043
10044 static bool
10045 translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
10046 {
10047 reloc_bfd_fix new_fix;
10048 asection *sec;
10049 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10050 removed_literal *removed;
10051 bfd_vma new_offset, target_offset;
10052
10053 if (fix->translated)
10054 return true;
10055
10056 sec = fix->target_sec;
10057 target_offset = fix->target_offset;
10058
10059 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10060 if (!relax_info)
10061 {
10062 fix->translated = true;
10063 return true;
10064 }
10065
10066 new_fix = *fix;
10067
10068 /* The fix does not need to be translated if the section cannot change. */
10069 if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10070 && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
10071 {
10072 fix->translated = true;
10073 return true;
10074 }
10075
10076 /* If the literal has been moved and this relocation was on an
10077 opcode, then the relocation should move to the new literal
10078 location. Otherwise, the relocation should move within the
10079 section. */
10080
10081 removed = false;
10082 if (is_operand_relocation (fix->src_type))
10083 {
10084 /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
10085 removed. */
10086 removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
10087 target_offset);
10088 }
10089
10090 if (removed)
10091 {
10092 asection *new_sec;
10093
10094 /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
10095 that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed. */
10096 BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
10097
10098 /* This was moved to some other address (possibly another section). */
10099 new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&removed->to);
10100 if (new_sec != sec)
10101 {
10102 sec = new_sec;
10103 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10104 if (!relax_info ||
10105 (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10106 && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
10107 {
10108 target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
10109 new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
10110 new_fix.target_offset = target_offset;
10111 new_fix.translated = true;
10112 *fix = new_fix;
10113 return true;
10114 }
10115 }
10116 target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
10117 new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
10118 }
10119
10120 /* The target address may have been moved within its section. */
10121 new_offset = offset_with_removed_text (&relax_info->action_list,
10122 target_offset);
10123
10124 new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
10125 new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
10126 new_fix.translated = true;
10127 *fix = new_fix;
10128 return true;
10129 }
10130
10131
10132 /* Fix up a relocation to take account of removed literals. */
10133
10134 static asection *
10135 translate_reloc (const r_reloc *orig_rel, r_reloc *new_rel, asection *sec)
10136 {
10137 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10138 removed_literal *removed;
10139 bfd_vma target_offset, base_offset;
10140
10141 *new_rel = *orig_rel;
10142
10143 if (!r_reloc_is_defined (orig_rel))
10144 return sec ;
10145
10146 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10147 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info && (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10148 || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section));
10149
10150 target_offset = orig_rel->target_offset;
10151
10152 removed = false;
10153 if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (orig_rel->rela.r_info)))
10154 {
10155 /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
10156 removed. */
10157 removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
10158 target_offset);
10159 }
10160 if (removed && removed->to.abfd)
10161 {
10162 asection *new_sec;
10163
10164 /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
10165 that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed. */
10166 BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
10167
10168 /* This was moved to some other address
10169 (possibly in another section). */
10170 *new_rel = removed->to;
10171 new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (new_rel);
10172 if (new_sec != sec)
10173 {
10174 sec = new_sec;
10175 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10176 if (!relax_info
10177 || (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10178 && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
10179 return sec;
10180 }
10181 target_offset = new_rel->target_offset;
10182 }
10183
10184 /* Find the base offset of the reloc symbol, excluding any addend from the
10185 reloc or from the section contents (for a partial_inplace reloc). Then
10186 find the adjusted values of the offsets due to relaxation. The base
10187 offset is needed to determine the change to the reloc's addend; the reloc
10188 addend should not be adjusted due to relaxations located before the base
10189 offset. */
10190
10191 base_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (new_rel) - new_rel->rela.r_addend;
10192 if (base_offset <= target_offset)
10193 {
10194 int base_removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10195 base_offset, false);
10196 int addend_removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10197 target_offset, false) -
10198 base_removed;
10199
10200 new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - base_removed - addend_removed;
10201 new_rel->rela.r_addend -= addend_removed;
10202 }
10203 else
10204 {
10205 /* Handle a negative addend. The base offset comes first. */
10206 int tgt_removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10207 target_offset, false);
10208 int addend_removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10209 base_offset, false) -
10210 tgt_removed;
10211
10212 new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - tgt_removed;
10213 new_rel->rela.r_addend += addend_removed;
10214 }
10215
10216 return sec;
10217 }
10218
10219
10220 /* For dynamic links, there may be a dynamic relocation for each
10221 literal. The number of dynamic relocations must be computed in
10222 size_dynamic_sections, which occurs before relaxation. When a
10223 literal is removed, this function checks if there is a corresponding
10224 dynamic relocation and shrinks the size of the appropriate dynamic
10225 relocation section accordingly. At this point, the contents of the
10226 dynamic relocation sections have not yet been filled in, so there's
10227 nothing else that needs to be done. */
10228
10229 static void
10230 shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
10231 bfd *abfd,
10232 asection *input_section,
10233 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10234 {
10235 struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
10236 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10237 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
10238 unsigned long r_symndx;
10239 int r_type;
10240 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10241 bool dynamic_symbol;
10242
10243 htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
10244 if (htab == NULL)
10245 return;
10246
10247 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10248 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
10249
10250 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10251 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10252
10253 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10254 h = NULL;
10255 else
10256 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
10257
10258 dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
10259
10260 if ((r_type == R_XTENSA_32 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
10261 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
10262 && (dynamic_symbol
10263 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
10264 && (!h || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))))
10265 {
10266 asection *srel;
10267 bool is_plt = false;
10268
10269 if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
10270 {
10271 srel = htab->elf.srelplt;
10272 is_plt = true;
10273 }
10274 else
10275 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
10276
10277 /* Reduce size of the .rela.* section by one reloc. */
10278 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
10279 BFD_ASSERT (srel->size >= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
10280 srel->size -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10281
10282 if (is_plt)
10283 {
10284 asection *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot;
10285 int reloc_index, chunk;
10286
10287 /* Find the PLT reloc index of the entry being removed. This
10288 is computed from the size of ".rela.plt". It is needed to
10289 figure out which PLT chunk to resize. Usually "last index
10290 = size - 1" since the index starts at zero, but in this
10291 context, the size has just been decremented so there's no
10292 need to subtract one. */
10293 reloc_index = srel->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10294
10295 chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
10296 splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
10297 sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
10298 BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
10299
10300 /* Check if an entire PLT chunk has just been eliminated. */
10301 if (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK == 0)
10302 {
10303 /* The two magic GOT entries for that chunk can go away. */
10304 srelgot = htab->elf.srelgot;
10305 BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL);
10306 srelgot->reloc_count -= 2;
10307 srelgot->size -= 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10308 sgotplt->size -= 8;
10309
10310 /* There should be only one entry left (and it will be
10311 removed below). */
10312 BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size == 4);
10313 BFD_ASSERT (splt->size == PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
10314 }
10315
10316 BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size >= 4);
10317 BFD_ASSERT (splt->size >= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
10318
10319 sgotplt->size -= 4;
10320 splt->size -= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10321 }
10322 }
10323 }
10324
10325
10326 /* Take an r_rel and move it to another section. This usually
10327 requires extending the interal_relocation array and pinning it. If
10328 the original r_rel is from the same BFD, we can complete this here.
10329 Otherwise, we add a fix record to let the final link fix the
10330 appropriate address. Contents and internal relocations for the
10331 section must be pinned after calling this routine. */
10332
10333 static bool
10334 move_literal (bfd *abfd,
10335 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
10336 asection *sec,
10337 bfd_vma offset,
10338 bfd_byte *contents,
10339 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info,
10340 Elf_Internal_Rela **internal_relocs_p,
10341 const literal_value *lit)
10342 {
10343 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = NULL;
10344 size_t new_relocs_count = 0;
10345 Elf_Internal_Rela this_rela;
10346 const r_reloc *r_rel;
10347
10348 r_rel = &lit->r_rel;
10349 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs == *internal_relocs_p);
10350
10351 if (r_reloc_is_const (r_rel))
10352 bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
10353 else
10354 {
10355 int r_type;
10356 unsigned i;
10357 reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10358 unsigned insert_at;
10359
10360 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
10361
10362 /* This is the difficult case. We have to create a fix up. */
10363 this_rela.r_offset = offset;
10364 this_rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
10365 this_rela.r_addend =
10366 r_rel->target_offset - r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
10367 bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
10368
10369 /* Currently, we cannot move relocations during a relocatable link. */
10370 BFD_ASSERT (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
10371 fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, offset, r_type,
10372 r_reloc_get_section (r_rel),
10373 r_rel->target_offset + r_rel->virtual_offset,
10374 false);
10375 /* We also need to mark that relocations are needed here. */
10376 sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
10377
10378 translate_reloc_bfd_fix (fix);
10379 /* This fix has not yet been translated. */
10380 add_fix (sec, fix);
10381
10382 /* Add the relocation. If we have already allocated our own
10383 space for the relocations and we have room for more, then use
10384 it. Otherwise, allocate new space and move the literals. */
10385 insert_at = sec->reloc_count;
10386 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; ++i)
10387 {
10388 if (this_rela.r_offset < (*internal_relocs_p)[i].r_offset)
10389 {
10390 insert_at = i;
10391 break;
10392 }
10393 }
10394
10395 if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs
10396 || sec->reloc_count + 1 > relax_info->allocated_relocs_count)
10397 {
10398 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->allocated_relocs == NULL
10399 || sec->reloc_count == relax_info->relocs_count);
10400
10401 if (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count == 0)
10402 new_relocs_count = (sec->reloc_count + 2) * 2;
10403 else
10404 new_relocs_count = (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count + 2) * 2;
10405
10406 new_relocs = (Elf_Internal_Rela *)
10407 bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * (new_relocs_count));
10408 if (!new_relocs)
10409 return false;
10410
10411 /* We could handle this more quickly by finding the split point. */
10412 if (insert_at != 0)
10413 memcpy (new_relocs, *internal_relocs_p,
10414 insert_at * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
10415
10416 new_relocs[insert_at] = this_rela;
10417
10418 if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
10419 memcpy (new_relocs + insert_at + 1,
10420 (*internal_relocs_p) + insert_at,
10421 (sec->reloc_count - insert_at)
10422 * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
10423
10424 if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs)
10425 {
10426 /* The first time we re-allocate, we can only free the
10427 old relocs if they were allocated with bfd_malloc.
10428 This is not true when keep_memory is in effect. */
10429 if (!link_info->keep_memory)
10430 free (*internal_relocs_p);
10431 }
10432 else
10433 free (*internal_relocs_p);
10434 relax_info->allocated_relocs = new_relocs;
10435 relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = new_relocs_count;
10436 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = new_relocs;
10437 sec->reloc_count++;
10438 relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
10439 *internal_relocs_p = new_relocs;
10440 }
10441 else
10442 {
10443 if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
10444 {
10445 unsigned idx;
10446 for (idx = sec->reloc_count; idx > insert_at; idx--)
10447 (*internal_relocs_p)[idx] = (*internal_relocs_p)[idx-1];
10448 }
10449 (*internal_relocs_p)[insert_at] = this_rela;
10450 sec->reloc_count++;
10451 if (relax_info->allocated_relocs)
10452 relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
10453 }
10454 }
10455 return true;
10456 }
10457
10458
10459 /* This is similar to relax_section except that when a target is moved,
10460 we shift addresses up. We also need to modify the size. This
10461 algorithm does NOT allow for relocations into the middle of the
10462 property sections. */
10463
10464 static bool
10465 relax_property_section (bfd *abfd,
10466 asection *sec,
10467 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
10468 {
10469 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
10470 bfd_byte *contents;
10471 unsigned i;
10472 bool ok = true;
10473 bool is_full_prop_section;
10474 size_t last_zfill_target_offset = 0;
10475 asection *last_zfill_target_sec = NULL;
10476 bfd_size_type sec_size;
10477 bfd_size_type entry_size;
10478
10479 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
10480 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
10481 link_info->keep_memory);
10482 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
10483 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
10484 {
10485 ok = false;
10486 goto error_return;
10487 }
10488
10489 is_full_prop_section = xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec);
10490 if (is_full_prop_section)
10491 entry_size = 12;
10492 else
10493 entry_size = 8;
10494
10495 if (internal_relocs)
10496 {
10497 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
10498 {
10499 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
10500 xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
10501 unsigned r_type;
10502 asection *target_sec;
10503 literal_value val;
10504 bfd_byte *size_p, *flags_p;
10505
10506 /* Locally change the source address.
10507 Translate the target to the new target address.
10508 If it points to this section and has been removed, MOVE IT.
10509 Also, don't forget to modify the associated SIZE at
10510 (offset + 4). */
10511
10512 irel = &internal_relocs[i];
10513 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
10514 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10515 continue;
10516
10517 /* Find the literal value. */
10518 r_reloc_init (&val.r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
10519 size_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 4];
10520 flags_p = NULL;
10521 if (is_full_prop_section)
10522 flags_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 8];
10523 BFD_ASSERT (irel->r_offset + entry_size <= sec_size);
10524
10525 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&val.r_rel);
10526 target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
10527
10528 if (target_relax_info
10529 && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10530 || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section ))
10531 {
10532 /* Translate the relocation's destination. */
10533 bfd_vma old_offset = val.r_rel.target_offset;
10534 bfd_vma new_offset;
10535 long old_size, new_size;
10536 int removed_by_old_offset =
10537 removed_by_actions_map (&target_relax_info->action_list,
10538 old_offset, false);
10539 new_offset = old_offset - removed_by_old_offset;
10540
10541 /* Assert that we are not out of bounds. */
10542 old_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, size_p);
10543 new_size = old_size;
10544
10545 if (old_size == 0)
10546 {
10547 /* Only the first zero-sized unreachable entry is
10548 allowed to expand. In this case the new offset
10549 should be the offset before the fill and the new
10550 size is the expansion size. For other zero-sized
10551 entries the resulting size should be zero with an
10552 offset before or after the fill address depending
10553 on whether the expanding unreachable entry
10554 preceeds it. */
10555 if (last_zfill_target_sec == 0
10556 || last_zfill_target_sec != target_sec
10557 || last_zfill_target_offset != old_offset)
10558 {
10559 bfd_vma new_end_offset = new_offset;
10560
10561 /* Recompute the new_offset, but this time don't
10562 include any fill inserted by relaxation. */
10563 removed_by_old_offset =
10564 removed_by_actions_map (&target_relax_info->action_list,
10565 old_offset, true);
10566 new_offset = old_offset - removed_by_old_offset;
10567
10568 /* If it is not unreachable and we have not yet
10569 seen an unreachable at this address, place it
10570 before the fill address. */
10571 if (flags_p && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, flags_p)
10572 & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0)
10573 {
10574 new_size = new_end_offset - new_offset;
10575
10576 last_zfill_target_sec = target_sec;
10577 last_zfill_target_offset = old_offset;
10578 }
10579 }
10580 }
10581 else
10582 {
10583 int removed_by_old_offset_size =
10584 removed_by_actions_map (&target_relax_info->action_list,
10585 old_offset + old_size, true);
10586 new_size -= removed_by_old_offset_size - removed_by_old_offset;
10587 }
10588
10589 if (new_size != old_size)
10590 {
10591 bfd_put_32 (abfd, new_size, size_p);
10592 pin_contents (sec, contents);
10593 }
10594
10595 if (new_offset != old_offset)
10596 {
10597 bfd_vma diff = new_offset - old_offset;
10598 irel->r_addend += diff;
10599 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10600 }
10601 }
10602 }
10603 }
10604
10605 /* Combine adjacent property table entries. This is also done in
10606 finish_dynamic_sections() but at that point it's too late to
10607 reclaim the space in the output section, so we do this twice. */
10608
10609 if (internal_relocs && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
10610 || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)))
10611 {
10612 Elf_Internal_Rela *last_irel = NULL;
10613 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *next_rel, *rel_end;
10614 int removed_bytes = 0;
10615 bfd_vma offset;
10616 flagword predef_flags;
10617
10618 predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (sec);
10619
10620 /* Walk over memory and relocations at the same time.
10621 This REQUIRES that the internal_relocs be sorted by offset. */
10622 qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
10623 internal_reloc_compare);
10624
10625 pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10626 pin_contents (sec, contents);
10627
10628 next_rel = internal_relocs;
10629 rel_end = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
10630
10631 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size % entry_size == 0);
10632
10633 for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
10634 {
10635 Elf_Internal_Rela *offset_rel, *extra_rel;
10636 bfd_vma bytes_to_remove, size, actual_offset;
10637 bool remove_this_rel;
10638 flagword flags;
10639
10640 /* Find the first relocation for the entry at the current offset.
10641 Adjust the offsets of any extra relocations for the previous
10642 entry. */
10643 offset_rel = NULL;
10644 if (next_rel)
10645 {
10646 for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
10647 {
10648 if ((irel->r_offset == offset
10649 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
10650 || irel->r_offset > offset)
10651 {
10652 offset_rel = irel;
10653 break;
10654 }
10655 irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
10656 }
10657 }
10658
10659 /* Find the next relocation (if there are any left). */
10660 extra_rel = NULL;
10661 if (offset_rel)
10662 {
10663 for (irel = offset_rel + 1; irel < rel_end; irel++)
10664 {
10665 if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
10666 {
10667 extra_rel = irel;
10668 break;
10669 }
10670 }
10671 }
10672
10673 /* Check if there are relocations on the current entry. There
10674 should usually be a relocation on the offset field. If there
10675 are relocations on the size or flags, then we can't optimize
10676 this entry. Also, find the next relocation to examine on the
10677 next iteration. */
10678 if (offset_rel)
10679 {
10680 if (offset_rel->r_offset >= offset + entry_size)
10681 {
10682 next_rel = offset_rel;
10683 /* There are no relocations on the current entry, but we
10684 might still be able to remove it if the size is zero. */
10685 offset_rel = NULL;
10686 }
10687 else if (offset_rel->r_offset > offset
10688 || (extra_rel
10689 && extra_rel->r_offset < offset + entry_size))
10690 {
10691 /* There is a relocation on the size or flags, so we can't
10692 do anything with this entry. Continue with the next. */
10693 next_rel = offset_rel;
10694 continue;
10695 }
10696 else
10697 {
10698 BFD_ASSERT (offset_rel->r_offset == offset);
10699 offset_rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
10700 next_rel = offset_rel + 1;
10701 }
10702 }
10703 else
10704 next_rel = NULL;
10705
10706 remove_this_rel = false;
10707 bytes_to_remove = 0;
10708 actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
10709 size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 4]);
10710
10711 if (is_full_prop_section)
10712 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 8]);
10713 else
10714 flags = predef_flags;
10715
10716 if (size == 0
10717 && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) == 0
10718 && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
10719 {
10720 /* Always remove entries with zero size and no alignment. */
10721 bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
10722 if (offset_rel)
10723 remove_this_rel = true;
10724 }
10725 else if (offset_rel
10726 && ELF32_R_TYPE (offset_rel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32)
10727 {
10728 if (last_irel)
10729 {
10730 flagword old_flags;
10731 bfd_vma old_size =
10732 bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
10733 bfd_vma old_address =
10734 (last_irel->r_addend
10735 + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset]));
10736 bfd_vma new_address =
10737 (offset_rel->r_addend
10738 + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset]));
10739 if (is_full_prop_section)
10740 old_flags = bfd_get_32
10741 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 8]);
10742 else
10743 old_flags = predef_flags;
10744
10745 if ((ELF32_R_SYM (offset_rel->r_info)
10746 == ELF32_R_SYM (last_irel->r_info))
10747 && old_address + old_size == new_address
10748 && old_flags == flags
10749 && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) == 0
10750 && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_LOOP_TARGET) == 0)
10751 {
10752 /* Fix the old size. */
10753 bfd_put_32 (abfd, old_size + size,
10754 &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
10755 bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
10756 remove_this_rel = true;
10757 }
10758 else
10759 last_irel = offset_rel;
10760 }
10761 else
10762 last_irel = offset_rel;
10763 }
10764
10765 if (remove_this_rel)
10766 {
10767 offset_rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
10768 offset_rel->r_offset = 0;
10769 }
10770
10771 if (bytes_to_remove != 0)
10772 {
10773 removed_bytes += bytes_to_remove;
10774 if (offset + bytes_to_remove < sec->size)
10775 memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
10776 &contents[actual_offset + bytes_to_remove],
10777 sec->size - offset - bytes_to_remove);
10778 }
10779 }
10780
10781 if (removed_bytes)
10782 {
10783 /* Fix up any extra relocations on the last entry. */
10784 for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
10785 irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
10786
10787 /* Clear the removed bytes. */
10788 memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
10789
10790 if (sec->rawsize == 0)
10791 sec->rawsize = sec->size;
10792 sec->size -= removed_bytes;
10793
10794 if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
10795 {
10796 asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (link_info)->sgotloc;
10797 if (sgotloc)
10798 sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
10799 }
10800 }
10801 }
10802
10803 error_return:
10804 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10805 release_contents (sec, contents);
10806 return ok;
10807 }
10808
10809 \f
10810 /* Third relaxation pass. */
10811
10812 /* Change symbol values to account for removed literals. */
10813
10814 bool
10815 relax_section_symbols (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10816 {
10817 xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10818 unsigned int sec_shndx;
10819 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10820 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10821 unsigned i, num_syms, num_locals;
10822
10823 relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10824 BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
10825
10826 if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10827 && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
10828 return true;
10829
10830 sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
10831
10832 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10833 isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10834
10835 num_syms = symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym);
10836 num_locals = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10837
10838 /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section. */
10839 for (i = 0; i < num_locals; i++)
10840 {
10841 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = &isymbuf[i];
10842
10843 if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx)
10844 {
10845 bfd_vma orig_addr = isym->st_value;
10846 int removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10847 orig_addr, false);
10848
10849 isym->st_value -= removed;
10850 if (ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC)
10851 isym->st_size -=
10852 removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10853 orig_addr + isym->st_size, false) -
10854 removed;
10855 }
10856 }
10857
10858 /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section. */
10859 for (i = 0; i < (num_syms - num_locals); i++)
10860 {
10861 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash;
10862
10863 sym_hash = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[i];
10864
10865 if (sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10866 sym_hash = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) sym_hash->root.u.i.link;
10867
10868 if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10869 || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10870 && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
10871 {
10872 bfd_vma orig_addr = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
10873 int removed = removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10874 orig_addr, false);
10875
10876 sym_hash->root.u.def.value -= removed;
10877
10878 if (sym_hash->type == STT_FUNC)
10879 sym_hash->size -=
10880 removed_by_actions_map (&relax_info->action_list,
10881 orig_addr + sym_hash->size, false) -
10882 removed;
10883 }
10884 }
10885
10886 return true;
10887 }
10888
10889 \f
10890 /* "Fix" handling functions, called while performing relocations. */
10891
10892 static bool
10893 do_fix_for_relocatable_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10894 bfd *input_bfd,
10895 asection *input_section,
10896 bfd_byte *contents)
10897 {
10898 r_reloc r_rel;
10899 asection *sec, *old_sec;
10900 bfd_vma old_offset;
10901 int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10902 reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10903
10904 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10905 return true;
10906
10907 fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10908 if (!fix)
10909 return true;
10910
10911 r_reloc_init (&r_rel, input_bfd, rel, contents,
10912 bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10913 old_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
10914 old_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
10915
10916 if (!old_sec || !r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
10917 {
10918 if (r_type != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
10919 {
10920 _bfd_error_handler
10921 /* xgettext:c-format */
10922 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): unexpected fix for %s relocation"),
10923 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
10924 elf_howto_table[r_type].name);
10925 return false;
10926 }
10927 /* Leave it be. Resolution will happen in a later stage. */
10928 }
10929 else
10930 {
10931 sec = fix->target_sec;
10932 rel->r_addend += ((sec->output_offset + fix->target_offset)
10933 - (old_sec->output_offset + old_offset));
10934 }
10935 return true;
10936 }
10937
10938
10939 static void
10940 do_fix_for_final_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10941 bfd *input_bfd,
10942 asection *input_section,
10943 bfd_byte *contents,
10944 bfd_vma *relocationp)
10945 {
10946 asection *sec;
10947 int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10948 reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10949 bfd_vma fixup_diff;
10950
10951 if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10952 return;
10953
10954 fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10955 if (!fix)
10956 return;
10957
10958 sec = fix->target_sec;
10959
10960 fixup_diff = rel->r_addend;
10961 if (elf_howto_table[fix->src_type].partial_inplace)
10962 {
10963 bfd_vma inplace_val;
10964 BFD_ASSERT (fix->src_offset
10965 < bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10966 inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, &contents[fix->src_offset]);
10967 fixup_diff += inplace_val;
10968 }
10969
10970 *relocationp = (sec->output_section->vma
10971 + sec->output_offset
10972 + fix->target_offset - fixup_diff);
10973 }
10974
10975 \f
10976 /* Miscellaneous utility functions.... */
10977
10978 static asection *
10979 elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10980 {
10981 bfd *dynobj;
10982 char plt_name[17];
10983
10984 if (chunk == 0)
10985 return elf_hash_table (info)->splt;
10986
10987 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10988 sprintf (plt_name, ".plt.%u", chunk);
10989 return bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, plt_name);
10990 }
10991
10992
10993 static asection *
10994 elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10995 {
10996 bfd *dynobj;
10997 char got_name[21];
10998
10999 if (chunk == 0)
11000 return elf_hash_table (info)->sgotplt;
11001
11002 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
11003 sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
11004 return bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, got_name);
11005 }
11006
11007
11008 /* Get the input section for a given symbol index.
11009 If the symbol is:
11010 . a section symbol, return the section;
11011 . a common symbol, return the common section;
11012 . an undefined symbol, return the undefined section;
11013 . an indirect symbol, follow the links;
11014 . an absolute value, return the absolute section. */
11015
11016 static asection *
11017 get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
11018 {
11019 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
11020 asection *target_sec = NULL;
11021 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
11022 {
11023 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
11024 unsigned int section_index;
11025
11026 isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
11027 section_index = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_shndx;
11028
11029 if (section_index == SHN_UNDEF)
11030 target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
11031 else if (section_index == SHN_ABS)
11032 target_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
11033 else if (section_index == SHN_COMMON)
11034 target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
11035 else
11036 target_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, section_index);
11037 }
11038 else
11039 {
11040 unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
11041 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
11042
11043 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
11044 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
11045 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
11046
11047 switch (h->root.type)
11048 {
11049 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
11050 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
11051 target_sec = h->root.u.def.section;
11052 break;
11053 case bfd_link_hash_common:
11054 target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
11055 break;
11056 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
11057 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
11058 target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
11059 break;
11060 default: /* New indirect warning. */
11061 target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
11062 break;
11063 }
11064 }
11065 return target_sec;
11066 }
11067
11068
11069 static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
11070 get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
11071 {
11072 unsigned long indx;
11073 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11074 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
11075
11076 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
11077 return NULL;
11078
11079 indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
11080 h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
11081 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
11082 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
11083 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
11084 return h;
11085 }
11086
11087
11088 /* Get the section-relative offset for a symbol number. */
11089
11090 static bfd_vma
11091 get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
11092 {
11093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
11094 bfd_vma offset = 0;
11095
11096 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
11097 {
11098 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
11099 isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
11100 offset = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_value;
11101 }
11102 else
11103 {
11104 unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
11105 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h =
11106 elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
11107
11108 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
11109 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
11110 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
11111 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
11112 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
11113 offset = h->root.u.def.value;
11114 }
11115 return offset;
11116 }
11117
11118
11119 static bool
11120 is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11121 {
11122 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
11123 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11124
11125 h = get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (abfd, r_symndx);
11126 if (h && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
11127 return true;
11128 return false;
11129 }
11130
11131
11132 static bool
11133 pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode opc,
11134 int opnd,
11135 bfd_vma self_address,
11136 bfd_vma dest_address)
11137 {
11138 xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
11139 uint32 valp = dest_address;
11140 if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opc, opnd, &valp, self_address)
11141 || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opc, opnd, &valp))
11142 return false;
11143 return true;
11144 }
11145
11146
11147 static bool
11148 xtensa_is_property_section (asection *sec)
11149 {
11150 if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec)
11151 || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)
11152 || xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
11153 return true;
11154
11155 return false;
11156 }
11157
11158
11159 static bool
11160 xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *sec)
11161 {
11162 if (startswith (sec->name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME)
11163 || startswith (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.x."))
11164 return true;
11165
11166 return false;
11167 }
11168
11169
11170 static bool
11171 xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *sec)
11172 {
11173 if (startswith (sec->name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME)
11174 || startswith (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.p."))
11175 return true;
11176
11177 return false;
11178 }
11179
11180
11181 static bool
11182 xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *sec)
11183 {
11184 if (startswith (sec->name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME)
11185 || startswith (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.prop."))
11186 return true;
11187
11188 return false;
11189 }
11190
11191
11192 static int
11193 internal_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11194 {
11195 const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
11196 const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
11197
11198 if (a->r_offset != b->r_offset)
11199 return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
11200
11201 /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
11202 but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
11203 from behaving differently with different implementations.
11204 Without the code below we get correct but different results
11205 on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8. We would like to always produce the
11206 same results no matter the host. */
11207
11208 if (a->r_info != b->r_info)
11209 return (a->r_info - b->r_info);
11210
11211 return (a->r_addend - b->r_addend);
11212 }
11213
11214
11215 static int
11216 internal_reloc_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11217 {
11218 const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
11219 const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
11220
11221 /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other; this shouldn't happen
11222 except when searching for a match. */
11223 return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
11224 }
11225
11226
11227 /* Predicate function used to look up a section in a particular group. */
11228
11229 static bool
11230 match_section_group (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *sec, void *inf)
11231 {
11232 const char *gname = inf;
11233 const char *group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
11234
11235 return (group_name == gname
11236 || (group_name != NULL
11237 && gname != NULL
11238 && strcmp (group_name, gname) == 0));
11239 }
11240
11241
11242 static char *
11243 xtensa_add_names (const char *base, const char *suffix)
11244 {
11245 if (suffix)
11246 {
11247 size_t base_len = strlen (base);
11248 size_t suffix_len = strlen (suffix);
11249 char *str = bfd_malloc (base_len + suffix_len + 1);
11250
11251 memcpy (str, base, base_len);
11252 memcpy (str + base_len, suffix, suffix_len + 1);
11253 return str;
11254 }
11255 else
11256 {
11257 return strdup (base);
11258 }
11259 }
11260
11261 static int linkonce_len = sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.") - 1;
11262
11263 static char *
11264 xtensa_property_section_name (asection *sec, const char *base_name,
11265 bool separate_sections)
11266 {
11267 const char *suffix, *group_name;
11268 char *prop_sec_name;
11269
11270 group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
11271 if (group_name)
11272 {
11273 suffix = strrchr (sec->name, '.');
11274 if (suffix == sec->name)
11275 suffix = 0;
11276 prop_sec_name = xtensa_add_names (base_name, suffix);
11277 }
11278 else if (startswith (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce."))
11279 {
11280 char *linkonce_kind = 0;
11281
11282 if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME) == 0)
11283 linkonce_kind = "x.";
11284 else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME) == 0)
11285 linkonce_kind = "p.";
11286 else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME) == 0)
11287 linkonce_kind = "prop.";
11288 else
11289 abort ();
11290
11291 prop_sec_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (strlen (sec->name)
11292 + strlen (linkonce_kind) + 1);
11293 memcpy (prop_sec_name, ".gnu.linkonce.", linkonce_len);
11294 strcpy (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, linkonce_kind);
11295
11296 suffix = sec->name + linkonce_len;
11297 /* For backward compatibility, replace "t." instead of inserting
11298 the new linkonce_kind (but not for "prop" sections). */
11299 if (startswith (suffix, "t.") && linkonce_kind[1] == '.')
11300 suffix += 2;
11301 strcat (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, suffix);
11302 }
11303 else
11304 {
11305 prop_sec_name = xtensa_add_names (base_name,
11306 separate_sections ? sec->name : NULL);
11307 }
11308
11309 return prop_sec_name;
11310 }
11311
11312
11313 static asection *
11314 xtensa_get_separate_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name,
11315 bool separate_section)
11316 {
11317 char *prop_sec_name;
11318 asection *prop_sec;
11319
11320 prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name,
11321 separate_section);
11322 prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
11323 match_section_group,
11324 (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
11325 free (prop_sec_name);
11326 return prop_sec;
11327 }
11328
11329 static asection *
11330 xtensa_get_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
11331 {
11332 asection *prop_sec;
11333
11334 /* Try individual property section first. */
11335 prop_sec = xtensa_get_separate_property_section (sec, base_name, true);
11336
11337 /* Refer to a common property section if individual is not present. */
11338 if (!prop_sec)
11339 prop_sec = xtensa_get_separate_property_section (sec, base_name, false);
11340
11341 return prop_sec;
11342 }
11343
11344
11345 asection *
11346 xtensa_make_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
11347 {
11348 char *prop_sec_name;
11349 asection *prop_sec;
11350
11351 /* Check if the section already exists. */
11352 prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name,
11353 elf32xtensa_separate_props);
11354 prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
11355 match_section_group,
11356 (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
11357 /* If not, create it. */
11358 if (! prop_sec)
11359 {
11360 flagword flags = (SEC_RELOC | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
11361 flags |= (bfd_section_flags (sec)
11362 & (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES));
11363
11364 prop_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags
11365 (sec->owner, strdup (prop_sec_name), flags);
11366 if (! prop_sec)
11367 return 0;
11368
11369 elf_group_name (prop_sec) = elf_group_name (sec);
11370 }
11371
11372 free (prop_sec_name);
11373 return prop_sec;
11374 }
11375
11376
11377 flagword
11378 xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *sec)
11379 {
11380 if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec))
11381 return (XTENSA_PROP_INSN
11382 | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
11383 | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
11384
11385 if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
11386 return (XTENSA_PROP_LITERAL
11387 | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
11388 | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
11389
11390 return 0;
11391 }
11392
11393 \f
11394 /* Other functions called directly by the linker. */
11395
11396 bool
11397 xtensa_callback_required_dependence (bfd *abfd,
11398 asection *sec,
11399 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
11400 deps_callback_t callback,
11401 void *closure)
11402 {
11403 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
11404 bfd_byte *contents;
11405 unsigned i;
11406 bool ok = true;
11407 bfd_size_type sec_size;
11408
11409 sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
11410
11411 /* ".plt*" sections have no explicit relocations but they contain L32R
11412 instructions that reference the corresponding ".got.plt*" sections. */
11413 if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
11414 && startswith (sec->name, ".plt"))
11415 {
11416 asection *sgotplt;
11417
11418 /* Find the corresponding ".got.plt*" section. */
11419 if (sec->name[4] == '\0')
11420 sgotplt = elf_hash_table (link_info)->sgotplt;
11421 else
11422 {
11423 char got_name[14];
11424 int chunk = 0;
11425
11426 BFD_ASSERT (sec->name[4] == '.');
11427 chunk = strtol (&sec->name[5], NULL, 10);
11428
11429 sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
11430 sgotplt = bfd_get_linker_section (sec->owner, got_name);
11431 }
11432 BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt);
11433
11434 /* Assume worst-case offsets: L32R at the very end of the ".plt"
11435 section referencing a literal at the very beginning of
11436 ".got.plt". This is very close to the real dependence, anyway. */
11437 (*callback) (sec, sec_size, sgotplt, 0, closure);
11438 }
11439
11440 /* Only ELF files are supported for Xtensa. Check here to avoid a segfault
11441 when building uclibc, which runs "ld -b binary /dev/null". */
11442 if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11443 return ok;
11444
11445 internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
11446 link_info->keep_memory);
11447 if (internal_relocs == NULL
11448 || sec->reloc_count == 0)
11449 return ok;
11450
11451 /* Cache the contents for the duration of this scan. */
11452 contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
11453 if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
11454 {
11455 ok = false;
11456 goto error_return;
11457 }
11458
11459 if (!xtensa_default_isa)
11460 xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
11461
11462 for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
11463 {
11464 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
11465 if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
11466 {
11467 r_reloc l32r_rel;
11468 asection *target_sec;
11469 bfd_vma target_offset;
11470
11471 r_reloc_init (&l32r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
11472 target_sec = NULL;
11473 target_offset = 0;
11474 /* L32Rs must be local to the input file. */
11475 if (r_reloc_is_defined (&l32r_rel))
11476 {
11477 target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&l32r_rel);
11478 target_offset = l32r_rel.target_offset;
11479 }
11480 (*callback) (sec, irel->r_offset, target_sec, target_offset,
11481 closure);
11482 }
11483 }
11484
11485 error_return:
11486 release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
11487 release_contents (sec, contents);
11488 return ok;
11489 }
11490
11491 /* The default literal sections should always be marked as "code" (i.e.,
11492 SHF_EXECINSTR). This is particularly important for the Linux kernel
11493 module loader so that the literals are not placed after the text. */
11494 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section elf_xtensa_special_sections[] =
11495 {
11496 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
11497 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
11498 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
11499 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".xtensa.info"), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
11500 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
11501 };
11502 \f
11503 #define ELF_TARGET_ID XTENSA_ELF_DATA
11504 #ifndef ELF_ARCH
11505 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM xtensa_elf32_le_vec
11506 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-xtensa-le"
11507 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM xtensa_elf32_be_vec
11508 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-xtensa-be"
11509 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_xtensa
11510
11511 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_XTENSA
11512 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_XTENSA_OLD
11513
11514 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x1000
11515 #endif /* ELF_ARCH */
11516
11517 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
11518 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
11519 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
11520 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 4
11521 #define elf_backend_want_dynbss 0
11522 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
11523 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
11524
11525 #define elf_info_to_howto elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela
11526
11527 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject elf_xtensa_mkobject
11528
11529 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data
11530 #define bfd_elf32_new_section_hook elf_xtensa_new_section_hook
11531 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_print_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data
11532 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section elf_xtensa_relax_section
11533 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup
11534 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup \
11535 elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup
11536 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags elf_xtensa_set_private_flags
11537 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create
11538
11539 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol
11540 #define elf_backend_check_relocs elf_xtensa_check_relocs
11541 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections
11542 #define elf_backend_discard_info elf_xtensa_discard_info
11543 #define elf_backend_ignore_discarded_relocs elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs
11544 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing elf_xtensa_final_write_processing
11545 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections
11546 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol
11547 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook
11548 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus
11549 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo
11550 #define elf_backend_hide_symbol elf_xtensa_hide_symbol
11551 #define elf_backend_object_p elf_xtensa_object_p
11552 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class
11553 #define elf_backend_relocate_section elf_xtensa_relocate_section
11554 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections
11555 #define elf_backend_always_size_sections elf_xtensa_always_size_sections
11556 #define elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym _bfd_elf_omit_section_dynsym_all
11557 #define elf_backend_special_sections elf_xtensa_special_sections
11558 #define elf_backend_action_discarded elf_xtensa_action_discarded
11559 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol
11560
11561 #include "elf32-target.h"